blob: a6af2f267df9c4a54ab82436bb7e91b8bf0b45ef [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
810
811Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
812functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
813
814Three other directives are provided to report some status:
815
816 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
817 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
818 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
819
820Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
821"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
822fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
823provide advice to the user.
824
825Example:
826
827 .if "${A}"
828 .if "${B}"
829 .notice "A=1, B=1"
830 .elif "${C}"
831 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
832 .elif "${D}"
833 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
834 .else
835 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
836 .endif
837 .else
838 .notice "A=0"
839 .endif
840
841
8422.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200843----------------
844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100845Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100846values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
847otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
848numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
849for every keyword. Supported units are :
850
851 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
852 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
853 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
854 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
855 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
856 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
857
858
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008592.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200860-------------
861
862 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
863 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
864 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
865 global
866 daemon
867 maxconn 256
868
869 defaults
870 mode http
871 timeout connect 5000ms
872 timeout client 50000ms
873 timeout server 50000ms
874
875 frontend http-in
876 bind *:80
877 default_backend servers
878
879 backend servers
880 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
881
882
883 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
884 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
885 global
886 daemon
887 maxconn 256
888
889 defaults
890 mode http
891 timeout connect 5000ms
892 timeout client 50000ms
893 timeout server 50000ms
894
895 listen http-in
896 bind *:80
897 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
898
899
900Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
901
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100902 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200903
904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009053. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906--------------------
907
908Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
909are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
910of them have command-line equivalents.
911
912The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
913
914 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200915 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200917 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200918 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200920 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - description
922 - deviceatlas-json-file
923 - deviceatlas-log-level
924 - deviceatlas-separator
925 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900926 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927 - gid
928 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100929 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200930 - h1-case-adjust
931 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100932 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100933 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100934 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200935 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200937 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100938 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200939 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100940 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100941 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200942 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200944 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200945 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100946 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200947 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200948 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100949 - presetenv
950 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 - uid
952 - ulimit-n
953 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200954 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100955 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100956 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200957 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200958 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200959 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200960 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200961 - ssl-default-bind-options
962 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200963 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - ssl-default-server-options
965 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100966 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200967 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100968 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100969 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100970 - 51degrees-data-file
971 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200972 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200973 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200974 - wurfl-data-file
975 - wurfl-information-list
976 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200977 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100978 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100981 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200982 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200984 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100985 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100986 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100987 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200988 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200989 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200990 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200991 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992 - noepoll
993 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000994 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100996 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300997 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000998 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100999 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001000 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001001 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001002 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001003 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001004 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001005 - tune.buffers.limit
1006 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001007 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001008 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001009 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001010 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001011 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001012 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001013 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001014 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001015 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001016 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001017 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001018 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001019 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001020 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001021 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1022 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001023 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001024 - tune.maxaccept
1025 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001026 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001027 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001028 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001029 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1030 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001031 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1032 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001033 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001034 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001035 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001036 - tune.sndbuf.client
1037 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001038 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001039 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001040 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001041 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001042 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001043 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001044 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001045 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001046 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001047 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001048 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1049 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1050 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001051 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1052 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001055 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001056 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
1058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060------------------------------------
1061
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001062ca-base <dir>
1063 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001064 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1065 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1066 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001067
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068chroot <jail dir>
1069 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1070 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1071 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1072 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1073 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001074 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001075
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001076cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1077 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1078 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1079 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1080 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1081 set. These sets have the format
1082
1083 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1084
1085 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001086 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001087 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1088 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001089 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1090 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001091 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1092 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1093 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1094 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1095 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1096 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1097 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1098 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1099 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1100 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001101
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001102 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1103 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1104 on the machine's word size.
1105
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001106 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001107 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1108 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1109 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1110 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1111 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1112 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001113
1114 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001115 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1116
1117 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1118 # first 4 CPUs
1119
1120 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1121 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1122 # word size.
1123
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001124 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001125 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001126 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1127 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1128 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1129
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001130 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1131 # and so on.
1132 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1133 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1134 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001136 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001137 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1138 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1139 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1140
1141 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1142 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1143 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1144
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1146 # and a thread range.
1147 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1148 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1149 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1150
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001151crt-base <dir>
1152 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001153 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1154 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156daemon
1157 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1158 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001159 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1160 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001162default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1163 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1164 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1165 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1166 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1167 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1168 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1169 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1170 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1171 not start with a slash ('/'):
1172 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1173 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1174
1175 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1176 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1177 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1178 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1179 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1180 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1181 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1182 each of them.
1183
1184 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1185 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1186 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1187 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1188 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1189 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1190 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1191 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1192
1193 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1194 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1195 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1196 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1197 made easily relocatable.
1198
1199 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1200 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1201 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1202 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1203 consistent across all configuration files.
1204
1205 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1206 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1207 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1208 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1209 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1210 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1211 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1212 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1213
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001214deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1215 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001216 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001217
1218deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001220 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1221
1222deviceatlas-separator <char>
1223 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1224 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1225
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001226deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001227 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1228 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1229 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001230
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001231external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001232 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1233 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001234 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1235 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1236 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1237 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1238 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001239
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001240gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001241 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1243 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001244 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1245 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001247
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001248group <group name>
1249 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1250 See also "gid" and "user".
1251
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001252hard-stop-after <time>
1253 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1254
1255 Arguments :
1256 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1257 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1258 SIGUSR1 signal.
1259
1260 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1261 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1262 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1263
1264 Example:
1265 global
1266 hard-stop-after 30s
1267
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001268h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1269 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1270 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1271 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1272 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001273 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001274 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1275 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1276 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1277 specified in a proxy.
1278
1279 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1280 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1281 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1282 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1283 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1284 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1285 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1286
1287 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1288 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1289 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1290 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1291 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1292
1293 Example:
1294 global
1295 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1296
1297 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1298 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1299
1300h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1301 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1302 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1303 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1304 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1305 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1306 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1307 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1308 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1309
1310 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1311 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1312 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1313
1314 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1315 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1316
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001317insecure-fork-wanted
1318 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1319 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1320 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1321 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1322 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1323 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1324 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1325 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1326 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1327 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1328 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1329 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1330 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1331 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1332 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1333 disable it.
1334
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001335insecure-setuid-wanted
1336 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1337 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1338 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1339 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1340 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1341 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1342 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1343 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1344 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1345 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1346 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1347 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1348 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1349 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1350
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001351issuers-chain-path <dir>
1352 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1353 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1354 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1355 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1356 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1357 "issuers-chain-path".
1358 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1359 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1360 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1361 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1362 will share the chain in memory.
1363
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001364localpeer <name>
1365 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1366 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1367 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1368 the configuration parsing.
1369
1370 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1371 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1372
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001373log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001374 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001375 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001376 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001377 configured with "log global".
1378
1379 <address> can be one of:
1380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001381 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001382 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1383 port).
1384
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001385 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1386 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1387 port).
1388
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001389 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001390 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1391 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001392 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001393
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001394 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1395 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1396 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1397 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1398 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1399 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1400 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1401 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1402 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1403 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1404 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1405 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1406 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1407 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001408 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1409 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001410
1411 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1412 "fd@2", see above.
1413
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001414 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1415 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1416 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1417 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1418 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1419
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001420 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1421 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001422
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001423 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1424 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1425 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1426 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1427 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1428 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1429 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1430 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1431 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1432 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001433 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1434 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001435
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001436 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1437 one of the following :
1438
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001439 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1440 field is stripped. This is the default.
1441 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1442 rfc3164.
1443
1444 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001445 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1446
1447 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1448 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1449
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001450 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1451 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1452 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1453 designed to be used with a local log server.
1454
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001455 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1456 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1457 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1458 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1459 logger consumes.
1460
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001461 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1462 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1463 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1464 used with a local log server.
1465
1466 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1467 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1468 designed to be used with a local log server.
1469
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001470 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1471 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1472 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1473 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1474
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001475 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1476 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1477 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1478 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1479 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1480
1481 <sample_size>
1482 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1483 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1484 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1485 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1486 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1487
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001488 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001489
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001490 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1491 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1492 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1493
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001494 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1495 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1496 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1497 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498
1499 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001500 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1501 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1502 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1503 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1504 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1505 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001506
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001507 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001508
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001509log-send-hostname [<string>]
1510 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1511 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1512 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1513 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1514 the logs.
1515
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001516log-tag <string>
1517 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1518 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1519 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001520 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001521
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001522lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001523 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1524 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1525 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1526 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1527 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1528 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001529 used multiple times.
1530
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001531lua-load-per-thread <file>
1532 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1533 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1534 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1535 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1536 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1537 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1538 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1539 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1540 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1541 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1542 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1543 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1544 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1545 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1546 times.
1547
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001548lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1549 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1550 variable.
1551 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1552 to "path".
1553
1554 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1555 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1556 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1557 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1558 will be checked earlier.
1559
1560 As an example by specifying the following path:
1561
1562 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1563 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1564
1565 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1566 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1567 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1568 paths if that does not exist either.
1569
1570 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1571 documentation.
1572
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001573master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001574 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1575 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1576 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001577 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001578 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1579 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001580 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1581 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1582 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1583 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1584 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001585
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001586 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001587
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001588mworker-max-reloads <number>
1589 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001590 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001591 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1592 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1593 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1594
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001595nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1597 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1598 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001599 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1600 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001601 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1602 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1603 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001605nbthread <number>
1606 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001607 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1608 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1609 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1610 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1611 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001612 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1613 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1614 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1615 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1616 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1617 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1618 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001619
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001620numa-cpu-mapping
1621 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1622 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1623 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1624 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1625 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1626 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1627 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1628 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1629 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001632 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1633 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1634 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1635 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001637pp2-never-send-local
1638 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1639 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1640 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1641 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1642 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1643 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1644 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1645 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1646 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1647 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1648 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1649
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001650presetenv <name> <value>
1651 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1652 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1653 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1654 and "unsetenv".
1655
1656resetenv [<name> ...]
1657 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1658 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1659 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1660 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1661 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1662 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1663 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1664 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1665
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001666stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001667 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1668 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1669 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1670 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1671 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1672 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001673 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001674 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1675 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1676 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1677 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001678
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001679server-state-base <directory>
1680 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001681 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1682 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001683
1684server-state-file <file>
1685 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1686 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1687 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1688 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1689 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1690 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1691 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1692 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001693 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1694 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001695
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001696set-var <var-name> <expr>
1697 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1698 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1699 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1700 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1701 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1702 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1703 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1704 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1705 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1706
1707 Example:
1708 global
1709 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1710 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1711 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1712
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001713setenv <name> <value>
1714 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1715 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1716 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1717 and "unsetenv".
1718
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001719set-dumpable
1720 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001721 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1722 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1723 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1724 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1725 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1726 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1727 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1728 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1729 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1730 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1731 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1732 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1733 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1734 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1735 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1736 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1737 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001738
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001739ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1741 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001742 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001743 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001744 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1745 information and recommendations see e.g.
1746 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1747 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1748 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1749 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001750
1751ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1753 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1754 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1755 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1756 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001757 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1758 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1759 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001760 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001761
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001762ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1764 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1765 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1766 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1767 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1768
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001769ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1771 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1772 keyword to see available options.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001776 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001777
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001778ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1780 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001781 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001782 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001783 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1784 information and recommendations see e.g.
1785 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1786 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1787 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1788 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1789 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001790
1791ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1793 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1794 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1795 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1796 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001797 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1798 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1799 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1800 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001801
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001802ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1804 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1805 keyword to see available options.
1806
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001807ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1809 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1810 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001811 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001812 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001813 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1814 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1815 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1816 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001817 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1818 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1819 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1820
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001821ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1822 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1823 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001824 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001825 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001826 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1827
1828 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001829
1830 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1831 and won't try to remove them.
1832
1833 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1834
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001835ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001836 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001837 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1838 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001839
1840 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1841 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1842 optimize the startup time.
1843
1844 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1845 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1846 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1847
1848 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001849 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001850
1851 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001852 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1853
1854 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1855 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1856 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1857 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1858 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1859 bind configuration..
1860
1861 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1862 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1863 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1864 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1865 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1866 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1867 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1868 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1869
1870 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1871
1872 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1873 a cert bundle.
1874
1875 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1876 separately in several "crt".
1877
1878 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1879 since files are loading separately.
1880
1881 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1882 required to commit them.
1883
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001884 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001885 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001886
1887 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1888
1889 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1890
1891 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1892 not provided in the PEM file.
1893
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001894 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1895 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1896
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001897 The default behavior is "all".
1898
1899 Example:
1900 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1901 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1902 ssl-load-extra-files none
1903
1904 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1905
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001906ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1907 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1908 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1909 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1910
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001911ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001912 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001913 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1914 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1915 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1916 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1917 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1918 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001919 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001920
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001921stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1922 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1923 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1924 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001925 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001926 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001927
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001928 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1929 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1930 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001931
1932stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1933 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1934 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001935 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001936
1937stats maxconn <connections>
1938 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1939 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1940
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001941uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001942 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001943 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1944 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1945 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1946
1947ulimit-n <number>
1948 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1949 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1950 option.
1951
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001952unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1953 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1954
1955 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1956 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1957 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1958 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1959 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1960 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1961 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1962 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1963 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1964 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1965
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001966unsetenv [<name> ...]
1967 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1968 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1969 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1970 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1971 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1972 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1973 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1974
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001975user <user name>
1976 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1977 See also "uid" and "group".
1978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001979node <name>
1980 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1981
1982 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1983 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1984 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1985 traffic.
1986
1987description <text>
1988 Add a text that describes the instance.
1989
1990 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1991 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1992 "<" and ">" characters.
1993
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100199451degrees-data-file <file path>
1995 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001996 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001997
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001998 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001999 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2000
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000200151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002002 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2003 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2004 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2005
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002006 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002007 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2008
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200200951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002010 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2011 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2012
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002013 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2014 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2015
201651degrees-cache-size <number>
2017 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2018 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2019 By default, this cache is disabled.
2020
2021 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002022 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2023
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002024wurfl-data-file <file path>
2025 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2026 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2027
2028 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2029 with USE_WURFL=1.
2030
2031wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2032 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2033 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2034 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2035
2036 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2037
2038 Valid WURFL properties are:
2039 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2040
2041 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2042 device.
2043
2044 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2045 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2046
2047 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2048 particular web request.
2049
2050 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2051 used Libwurfl API version.
2052
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002053 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2054 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2055
2056 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2057 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2058
2059 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2060
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002061 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2062 with USE_WURFL=1.
2063
2064wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2065 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2066 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2067
2068 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2069 with USE_WURFL=1.
2070
2071wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2072 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2073 thus before the chroot.
2074
2075 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2076 with USE_WURFL=1.
2077
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002078wurfl-cache-size <size>
2079 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2080 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002081 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002082 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002083
2084 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2085 with USE_WURFL=1.
2086
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002087strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002088 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2089 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2090 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2091 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2092 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002095-----------------------
2096
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002097busy-polling
2098 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2099 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2100 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2101 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2102 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2103 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2104 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2105 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2106 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2107 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2108 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2109 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2110 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2111 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2112 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2113 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2114 "poll" pollers.
2115
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002116 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2117 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2118 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2119
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002120max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2121 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2122 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2123 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2124 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2125 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2126 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2127 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2128 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130maxconn <number>
2131 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2132 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2133 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002134 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2135 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2136 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2137 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002138 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2139 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2140 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2141 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2142 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2143 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002144
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002145maxconnrate <number>
2146 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2147 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2148 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2149 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2150 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2151 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2152 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2153 fairness.
2154
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002155maxcomprate <number>
2156 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002157 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002158 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2159 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2160 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002161 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002162 default value.
2163
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002164maxcompcpuusage <number>
2165 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2166 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2167 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2168 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2169 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2170 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2171 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2172 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2173
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002174maxpipes <number>
2175 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2176 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2177 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2178 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2179 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2180 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2181
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002182maxsessrate <number>
2183 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2184 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2185 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2186 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2187 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2188 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2189 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2190 fairness.
2191
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002192maxsslconn <number>
2193 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2194 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2195 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2196 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2197 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2198 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2199 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002200 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2201 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2202 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2203 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2204 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2205 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2206 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002207
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002208maxsslrate <number>
2209 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2210 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2211 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2212 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2213 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2214 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2215 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2216 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2217 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2218 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2219
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002220maxzlibmem <number>
2221 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2222 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2223 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002224 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2225 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2226 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002228noepoll
2229 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2230 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002231 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002232
2233nokqueue
2234 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2235 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2236 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2237
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002238noevports
2239 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2240 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2241 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2242 also "nopoll".
2243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002244nopoll
2245 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2246 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002247 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002248 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2249 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002251nosplice
2252 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002253 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002254 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002255 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002256 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2257 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2258 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2259 "option splice-response".
2260
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002261nogetaddrinfo
2262 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2263 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2264
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002265noreuseport
2266 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2267 command line argument "-dR".
2268
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002269profiling.memory { on | off }
2270 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2271 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2272 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2273 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2274 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2275 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2276 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2277 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2278 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2279
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002280profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2281 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2282 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2283 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2284 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002285 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002286 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2287 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2288 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2289 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2290
2291 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2292 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2293 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2294 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2295 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002296 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2297 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2298 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2299 CLI.
2300
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002301spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002302 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2303 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2304 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2305 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2306 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2307 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002308
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002309ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002310 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002311 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002312 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2313 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2314 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2315 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2316 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2318 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002319 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2320 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2321 openssl configuration file uses:
2322 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2323
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002324ssl-mode-async
2325 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002326 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002327 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2328 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2329 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002330 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002331 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002332
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002333tune.buffers.limit <number>
2334 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2335 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2336 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2337 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2338 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002340 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2341 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2342 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2343 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2344 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2345 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2346 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2347 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2348 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2349
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002350tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2351 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2352 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2353 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2354 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2355
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002356tune.bufsize <number>
2357 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2358 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2359 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2360 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2361 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2362 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2363 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002364 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2365 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2366 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002367 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002368 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2369 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2370 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002371
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002372tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2373 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002374
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002375tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2376 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2377 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2378 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2379 this value. The default value is 1.
2380
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002381tune.fail-alloc
2382 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2383 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2384 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2385 gracefully.
2386
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002387tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2388 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2389 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2390 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2391 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2392 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2393
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002394tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2395 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2396 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2397 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2398 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2399 change it.
2400
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002401tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2402 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2404 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002405 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2406 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2407 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2408 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2409 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2410
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002411tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2412 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2413 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2414 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2415 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2416 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2417 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2418 recommended not to change this value.
2419
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002420tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2421 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2422 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2423 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2424 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2425 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2426 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2427 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2428
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002429tune.http.cookielen <number>
2430 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2431 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2432 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2433 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2434 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2435 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2436 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2437 to change this value.
2438
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002439tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002440 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2441 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002442 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002443 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002444 configuration directives too.
2445 The default value is 1024.
2446
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002447tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2448 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2449 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2450 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2451 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2452 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2453 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002454 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2455 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2456 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002457
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002458tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2460 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2461 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2462 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2463 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2464 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002465 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2466 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2467 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2468 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2469 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002470
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002471tune.idletimer <timeout>
2472 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2473 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2474 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2475 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2476 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2477 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002478 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002479 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002480 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2481
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002482tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2483 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2484 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2485 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2486 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2487 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2488 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2489 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2490 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2491 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2492
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002493tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2494 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002495 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002496 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2497 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002499 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2500 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2501
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002502tune.lua.maxmem
2503 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2504 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2505 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2506 memory.
2507
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002508tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2509 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002510 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2511 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002512 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002513
2514tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2515 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2516 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2517 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2518 check servers.
2519
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002520tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2521 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2522 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2523 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002524 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002525
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002526tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002527 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2528 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002529 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2530 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2531 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2532 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2533 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2534 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2535 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2536 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2537 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002538
2539tune.maxpollevents <number>
2540 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2541 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2542 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2543 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2544 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2545
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002546tune.maxrewrite <number>
2547 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2548 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2549 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2550 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2551 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2552 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2553 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2554 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2555 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2556 bufsize.
2557
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002558tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2559 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2560 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2561 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2562 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2563 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2564 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2565 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2566 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2567 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002568 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2569 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002570 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2571 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2572 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2573 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2574 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2575 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2576 setting this parameter to 0.
2577
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002578tune.pipesize <number>
2579 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2580 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2581 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2582 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2583 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2584 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2585
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002586tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2587 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2588 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2589 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2590 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2591 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2592 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002593 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002594
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002595tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2596 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2597 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2598 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2599 default is 20.
2600
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002601tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2602tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2603 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2604 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2605 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002606 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002607 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002608 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2609 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2610
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002611tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002613 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2614 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2615 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2616 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2617
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002618tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002619 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002620 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2621 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2622 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2623 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2624 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2625 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2626 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002627
2628tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2629 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2630 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2631 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2632 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2633 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2634 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2635 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2636 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2637 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002638
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002639tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2640tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2641 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2642 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2643 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002644 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002645 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002646 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2647 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2648 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2649 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2650 notifying haproxy again.
2651
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002652tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002653 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002654 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2655 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2656 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2657 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2658 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2659 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2660 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2661 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2662 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2663 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2664 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002665
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002666tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002667 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002668 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2669 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2670 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2671 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2672 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2673
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002674tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2675 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2676 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2677 performances. This is disabled by default.
2678
2679 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2680 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2681
2682 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2683
2684 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2685
2686 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2687
2688 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2689 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2690 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2691
2692 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2693 converted.
2694
2695 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2696 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2697 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2698 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2699 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2700 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2701 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002702 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2703 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002704
2705 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2706
2707 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2708 only need this line:
2709
2710 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2711
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002712tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2713 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002714 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002715 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2716 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2717 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2718 being used for too long.
2719
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002720tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2721 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2722 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2723 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2724 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2725 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2726 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2727 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2728 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2729 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2730 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002731 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002732 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002733
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002734tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2735 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2736 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2737 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2738 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002739 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002740 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2741 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002742 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2743 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002744
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002745tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2746 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2747 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2748 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2749 1000 entries.
2750
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002751tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2752 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2753 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2754 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2755
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002756tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002757tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002758tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2759tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2760tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002761 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2762 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2763 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2764 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2765 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2766 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2767 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2768 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002769
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002770 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2771 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2772 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2773 all available space is consumed.
2774 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2775 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2776 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002777
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002778tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2779 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002780 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002781 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002782 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002783 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2784
2785tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2786 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2787 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002788 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2789 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027913.3. Debugging
2792--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002793
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002794quiet
2795 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2796 line argument "-q".
2797
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002798zero-warning
2799 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2800 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2801 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2802 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2803 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2804 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2805
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028073.4. Userlists
2808--------------
2809It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2810http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2811it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2812
2813userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002814 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002815 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2816
2817group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002818 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002819 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2820 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2821
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002822user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2823 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002824 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2825 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002826 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2827 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2828 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2829 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002830
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002831 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2832 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2833 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2834 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2835 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2836 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2837 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2838 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2839 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002840
2841 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002842 userlist L1
2843 group G1 users tiger,scott
2844 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2847 user scott insecure-password elgato
2848 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002850 userlist L2
2851 group G1
2852 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002854 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2855 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2856 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002857
2858 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002859
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002860
28613.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002862----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002863It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2864several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2865instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2866values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2867automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2868In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2869using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2870tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2871reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2872Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2873that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2874each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002875
2876peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2879
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002880bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2881 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2882 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2883
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002884disabled
2885 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2886 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2887 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2888
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002889default-bind [param*]
2890 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2891
2892default-server [param*]
2893 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2894
2895 Arguments:
2896 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2897 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2898 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2899 details.
2900
2901
2902 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2903
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002904enable
2905 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2906
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002907log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002908 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2909 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2910 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2911 more details.
2912
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002913peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002914 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2915 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002916 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2917 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2918 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2919 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2920 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002921
2922 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2923 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2924
2925 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002926 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2927 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2928 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002929
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002930 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2931 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002932
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002933 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2934 "server" keyword explanation below).
2935
2936server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002937 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002938 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2939 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2940 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2941 of this "peers" section).
2942 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2943
2944
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002945 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002946 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002947 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002948 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2949 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2950 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002951
2952 backend mybackend
2953 mode tcp
2954 balance roundrobin
2955 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2956 stick on src
2957
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002958 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2959 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002960
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002961 Example:
2962 peers mypeers
2963 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2964 default-server ssl verify none
2965 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2966 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002967
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002968
2969table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2970 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2971
2972 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2973 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002974 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002975 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2976 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2977 "stick-table" keyword).
2978
2979 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2980 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2981 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2982 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2983 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2984 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2985 of the stick-table name as follows:
2986
2987 peers mypeers
2988 peer A ...
2989 peer B ...
2990 table t1 ...
2991
2992 frontend fe1
2993 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2994
2995 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2996 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2997
2998 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2999 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3000 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3001 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3002 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3003 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3004 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3005
3006 peers mypeers
3007 peer A ...
3008 peer B ...
3009 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3010
3011 backend t1
3012 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3013
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003014 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003015 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3016 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3017
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030183.6. Mailers
3019------------
3020It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3021If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3022in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3023
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003024mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003025 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3026 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3027
3028mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3029 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3030
3031 Example:
3032 mailers mymailers
3033 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3034 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3035
3036 backend mybackend
3037 mode tcp
3038 balance roundrobin
3039
3040 email-alert mailers mymailers
3041 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3042 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3043
3044 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3045 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3046
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003047timeout mail <time>
3048 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3049 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3050 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3051 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3052
3053 Example:
3054 mailers mymailers
3055 timeout mail 20s
3056 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003057
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020030583.7. Programs
3059-------------
3060In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3061master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3062managed the same way as the workers.
3063
3064During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3065sequence as a worker:
3066
3067 - the master is re-executed
3068 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3069 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3070 instance of the program
3071
3072During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3073
3074program <name>
3075 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3076 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3077 the management guide).
3078
3079command <command> [arguments*]
3080 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3081 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3082 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3083 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3084
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003085user <user name>
3086 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3087 See also "group".
3088
3089group <group name>
3090 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3091 See also "user".
3092
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003093option start-on-reload
3094no option start-on-reload
3095 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3096 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3097 program section.
3098
3099
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031003.8. HTTP-errors
3101----------------
3102
3103It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3104imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3105several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3106
3107http-errors <name>
3108 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3109 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3110
3111errorfile <code> <file>
3112 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3113
3114 Arguments :
3115 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003116 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003117 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003118
3119 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3120 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3121 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3122 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3123 before any chroot is performed.
3124
3125 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3126
3127 Example:
3128 http-errors website-1
3129 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3130 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3131 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3132
3133 http-errors website-2
3134 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3135 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3136 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3137
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031383.9. Rings
3139----------
3140
3141It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3142servers or traces.
3143
3144ring <ringname>
3145 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3146
3147description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003148 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003149 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3150
3151format <format>
3152 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3153
3154 Arguments:
3155 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3156 one of the following :
3157
3158 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3159 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3160 designed to be used with a local log server.
3161
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003162 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3163 field is stripped. This is the default.
3164 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3165 rfc3164.
3166
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003167 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3168 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3169 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3170 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3171 is the default.
3172
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003173 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003174 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3175
3176 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3177 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3178
3179 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3180 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3181 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3182 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3183 logger consumes.
3184
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003185 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3186 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3187 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3188 with a local log server.
3189
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003190 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3191 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3192 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3193 used with a local log server.
3194
3195maxlen <length>
3196 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3197 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3198 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3199
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003200server <name> <address> [param*]
3201 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3202 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3203 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3204 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3205 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3206 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3207 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3208 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3209 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003210 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3211 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003212
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003213size <size>
3214 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3215 set to BUFSIZE.
3216
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003217timeout connect <timeout>
3218 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3219
3220 Arguments :
3221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3223 as explained at the top of this document.
3224
3225timeout server <timeout>
3226 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3227
3228 Arguments :
3229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3231 as explained at the top of this document.
3232
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003233 Example:
3234 global
3235 log ring@myring local7
3236
3237 ring myring
3238 description "My local buffer"
3239 format rfc3164
3240 maxlen 1200
3241 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003242 timeout connect 5s
3243 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003244 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003245
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032463.10. Log forwarding
3247-------------------
3248
3249It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3250haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3251
3252log-forward <name>
3253 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3254
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003255backlog <conns>
3256 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3257 on connections accept.
3258
3259bind <addr> [param*]
3260 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003261 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3262 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3263 syslog protocol over TCP.
3264 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003265 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3266
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003267dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003268 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3269 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3270 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3271 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003272 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003273
3274log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003275log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003276 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3277 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3278 documentation.
3279 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3280 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3281 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3282 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3283 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3284
3285 Example:
3286 global
3287 log stderr format iso local7
3288
3289 ring myring
3290 description "My local buffer"
3291 format rfc5424
3292 maxlen 1200
3293 size 32764
3294 timeout connect 5s
3295 timeout server 10s
3296 # syslog tcp server
3297 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3298
3299 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003300 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3301 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003302 # all messages on stderr
3303 log global
3304 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3305 log ring@myring local0
3306 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3307 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3308 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3309 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3310 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003311
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003312maxconn <conns>
3313 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3314 10 is the default.
3315
3316timeout client <timeout>
3317 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003320----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003322Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003323 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3324 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3325 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3326 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003327
3328A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3329connections.
3330
3331A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3332to forward incoming connections.
3333
3334A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3335parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3336
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003337A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3338ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3339sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3340the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3341explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3342from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3343"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3344for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3345to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3346optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3347are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3348any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3349names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3350that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3351duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3352names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3353
3354Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3355settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3356of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3357profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3358timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3361'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3362case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3363
3364Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3365logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3366proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3367However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3368name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3369
3370Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3371and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003372bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3374modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3375arbitrary criteria.
3376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003377In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3378a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003379the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003380
3381 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3382 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3383 between responses and new requests.
3384
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003385 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3386 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3387 client-facing connection remains open.
3388
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003389 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3390 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003391
3392The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3393frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3394following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003395weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003396
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003397 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003398
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003399 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3400 ----+-----+-----+----
3401 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3402 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003403 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3404 ----+-----+-----+----
3405 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003406
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003407It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3408only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3409into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3410as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3411content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3412and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3413possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003415There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3416first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3417processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3418second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3419protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3420is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3421new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3422to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3423process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3424already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3425HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3426evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3427one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3428
3429There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3430performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3431tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3432preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3433analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3434HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3435header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3436mitigate this drawback.
3437
3438It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3439method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3440set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3441in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3442is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3443to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3444above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3445to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3446"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3447frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3448frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3449as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3450upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3451on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3452the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3453upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3454frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3455remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3458--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003460The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3461limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3462they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3463limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003464marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003465option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003466and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3467with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3468specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003470
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003471 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3472------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3473acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003474backlog X X X -
3475balance X - X X
3476bind - X X -
3477bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003478capture cookie - X X -
3479capture request header - X X -
3480capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003481clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3482clitcpka-idle X X X -
3483clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003484compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003485cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003486declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003487default-server X - X X
3488default_backend X X X -
3489description - X X X
3490disabled X X X X
3491dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003492email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003493email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003494email-alert mailers X X X X
3495email-alert myhostname X X X X
3496email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003497enabled X X X X
3498errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003499errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003500errorloc X X X X
3501errorloc302 X X X X
3502-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3503errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003504force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003505filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003506fullconn X - X X
3507grace X X X X
3508hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003509http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003510http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003511http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003512http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003513http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003514http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003515http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003516http-check set-var X - X X
3517http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003518http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003519http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003520http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003521http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003522http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003523id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003524ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003525load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003526log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003527log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003528log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003529log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003530max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531maxconn X X X -
3532mode X X X X
3533monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534monitor-uri X X X -
3535option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3536option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3537option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3538option allbackups (*) X - X X
3539option checkcache (*) X - X X
3540option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3541option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003542option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003543option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3544option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3546option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003547option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3548option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003549option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003550option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003551option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003552option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003553option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3555option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3556option httpchk X - X X
3557option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003558option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003560option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003561option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003562option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3564option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3565option logasap (*) X X X -
3566option mysql-check X - X X
3567option nolinger (*) X X X X
3568option originalto X X X X
3569option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003570option pgsql-check X - X X
3571option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003572option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003573option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574option smtpchk X - X X
3575option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3576option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3577option splice-request (*) X X X X
3578option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003579option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003580option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3581option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3582-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003583option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003584option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3585option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3586option tcpka X X X X
3587option tcplog X X X X
3588option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003589external-check command X - X X
3590external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3592rate-limit sessions X X X -
3593redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003595retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003596retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003598server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003599server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003601srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3602srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3603srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003604stats admin - X X X
3605stats auth X X X X
3606stats enable X X X X
3607stats hide-version X X X X
3608stats http-request - X X X
3609stats realm X X X X
3610stats refresh X X X X
3611stats scope X X X X
3612stats show-desc X X X X
3613stats show-legends X X X X
3614stats show-node X X X X
3615stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3617stick match - - X X
3618stick on - - X X
3619stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003620stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003621stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003622tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003623tcp-check connect X - X X
3624tcp-check expect X - X X
3625tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003626tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003627tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003628tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003629tcp-check set-var X - X X
3630tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003631tcp-request connection - X X -
3632tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003633tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003634tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003635tcp-response content - - X X
3636tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637timeout check X - X X
3638timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003639timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3642timeout http-request X X X X
3643timeout queue X - X X
3644timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003645timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003647timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003649unique-id-format X X X -
3650unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003652use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003653use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3655 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3659---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
3661This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3662
3663
3664acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3665 Declare or complete an access list.
3666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 no | yes | yes | yes
3668 Example:
3669 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3670 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3671 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003673 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
3675
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003676backlog <conns>
3677 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | yes | yes | no
3680 Arguments :
3681 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3682 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003683 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003684
3685 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3686 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3687 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3688 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3689 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3690 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3691 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3692 backlog parameter.
3693
3694 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3695 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3696 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3697
3698 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3699
3700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003702balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003703 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | no | yes | yes
3706 Arguments :
3707 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3708 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3709 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3710 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3711
3712 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3713 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3714 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3715 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003716 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003717 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003718 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3719 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3720 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3721 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3722 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3723 it, so that you don't worry.
3724
3725 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3726 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3727 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3728 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3729 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3730 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3731 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3732 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003734 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3735 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3736 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3737 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3738 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3739 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3740 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003741 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3742 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3743 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003744
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003745 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003746 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003747 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3748 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003749 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003750 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3751 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3752 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3753 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3754 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003755 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3756 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3757 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3758 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3759 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3760 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3763 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3764 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3765 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3766 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3767 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3768 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3769 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003770 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003772 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3773 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3774 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003776 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3777 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3778 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3779 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3780 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3781 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3782 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3783 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3784 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3785 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3786 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3787 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003789 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003790 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3791 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3792 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3793 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3794 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3795 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3796 URIs start with a leading "/".
3797
3798 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3799 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3800 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3801 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3802
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003803 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3804 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3805 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3806 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003809 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3810
3811 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003812 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3813 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003814 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3815 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3816 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3817 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003818 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003819 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3820 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003821
3822 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3823 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3824 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3825 server will receive the request.
3826
3827 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3828 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3829 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3830 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3831 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003832 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3833 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3834 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003836 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3837 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3838 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3839 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3840 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003842 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003843 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3844 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3845 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3846
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003847 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3848 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3849 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3850
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003851 random
3852 random(<draws>)
3853 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003854 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3855 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3856 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3857 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003858 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3859 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3860 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3861 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3862 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3863 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3864 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3865 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3866 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3867 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3868 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3869 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3870 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3871 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3872 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3873 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3874 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3875 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3876 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3877 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003878
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003879 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003880 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003881 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3882 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3883 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3884 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3885 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3886 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003887 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003888 used instead.
3889
3890 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3891 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3892 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3893 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3894
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003895 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3896 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3897 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3898
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003899 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003902 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3903 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003904
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003905 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3906 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3907 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003909 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003910 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003911 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3912 NTLM relies on.
3913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 Examples :
3915 balance roundrobin
3916 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003917 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003918 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3919 balance hdr(host)
3920 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003921
3922 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3923 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003925 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003926 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3927 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3928 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003929 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003930
3931 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3932 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3933 defaults to 16 kB.
3934
3935 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3936 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3937
3938 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3939 Round Robin.
3940
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003941 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003942 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3943 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3944 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3945
3946 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3947
3948 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003950 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3951 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3952 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003953
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003954 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955
3956
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003957bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3958bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 no | yes | yes | no
3962 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003963 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3964 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3965 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3966 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003967 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003968 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3969 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3970 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3971 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3972 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3973 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003974 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003975 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3976 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003977 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003978 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3979 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003980 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003981 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3982 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003983 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003984 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3985 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3986 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3987 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3988 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3989 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3990 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003991 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3992 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3993 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003994 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3995 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3996 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3997 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3999 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4000 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004001
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004002 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4003 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004004 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4005 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4006 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004007 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4008 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4009 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4010 the range.
4011
4012 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4013 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4014 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4015 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4016 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4017 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4018 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004019 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004020 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004021
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004022 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004023 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004024 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4025 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4026 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4027 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4028 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4029 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004031 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4032 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4033 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4034 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004036 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4037 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4038 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4039 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4040 in a frontend.
4041
4042 Example :
4043 listen http_proxy
4044 bind :80,:443
4045 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004046 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004048 listen http_https_proxy
4049 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004050 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004051
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004052 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4053 bind ipv6@:80
4054 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4055 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4056
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004057 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004058 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004059
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004060 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4061 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4062 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4063 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4064 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4065
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004066 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004067 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004068
4069
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004070bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004071 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4073 yes | yes | yes | yes
4074 Arguments :
4075 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4076 may be used to override a default value.
4077
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004078 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004079 option may be combined with other numbers.
4080
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004081 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004082 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4083 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4084 missing from all processes.
4085
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004086 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004087 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004088 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4089 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4090 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4091 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4092 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004093 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004094
4095 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4096 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4097 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4098 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4099 and 'even' instances.
4100
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004101 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4102 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4103 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4104 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004105
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004106 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4107 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4108
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004109 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4110 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4111 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4112
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004113 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4114 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4115
4116 Example :
4117 listen app_ip1
4118 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004119 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004120
4121 listen app_ip2
4122 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004123 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004124
4125 listen management
4126 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004127 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004128
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004129 listen management
4130 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4131 bind-process 1-4
4132
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004133 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004134
4135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004136capture cookie <name> len <length>
4137 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4139 no | yes | yes | no
4140 Arguments :
4141 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4142 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4143 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4144 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004145 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004146
4147 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4148 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4149 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4150 right if it exceeds <length>.
4151
4152 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4153 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4154 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4155 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4156
4157 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4158 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4159 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4160
4161 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4162 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4163 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004164 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4165 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4166 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167
4168 Example:
4169 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4170
4171 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004172 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004173
4174
4175capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004176 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 no | yes | yes | no
4179 Arguments :
4180 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004181 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4183 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4184 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4185
4186 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4187 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4188 it exceeds <length>.
4189
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004190 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4192 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004193 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4194 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4195 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4196 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004197 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004198 environments to find where the request came from.
4199
4200 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4201 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4202 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4203 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004205 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4206 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4207 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4208 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4209 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004210
4211 Example:
4212 capture request header Host len 15
4213 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004214 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004216 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217 about logging.
4218
4219
4220capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004221 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 no | yes | yes | no
4224 Arguments :
4225 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004226 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004227 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4228 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4229 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4230
4231 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4232 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4233 it exceeds <length>.
4234
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004235 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4237 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4238 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004239 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4240 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4241 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4242 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004243
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004244 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4245 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4246 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4247 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4248 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004249
4250 Example:
4251 capture response header Content-length len 9
4252 capture response header Location len 15
4253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004254 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255 about logging.
4256
4257
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004258clitcpka-cnt <count>
4259 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4260 the connection on the client side.
4261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 yes | yes | yes | no
4263 Arguments :
4264 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4265
4266 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4267 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004268 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4269 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004270
4271 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4272
4273
4274clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4275 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4276 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4277 client side.
4278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4279 yes | yes | yes | no
4280 Arguments :
4281 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4282 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4283 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4284 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4285
4286 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4287 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004288 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4289 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004290
4291 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4292
4293
4294clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4295 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | yes | yes | no
4298 Arguments :
4299 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4300 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4301 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4302 document.
4303
4304 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4305 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004306 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4307 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004308
4309 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4310
4311
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004312compression algo <algorithm> ...
4313compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004314compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004315 Enable HTTP compression.
4316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 yes | yes | yes | yes
4318 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004319 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4320 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4321 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4322
4323 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004324 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4325 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4326 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004327
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004328 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004329 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004330
4331 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4332 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4333 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4334 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4335 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004336 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004337
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004338 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4339 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4340 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4341 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4342 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4343 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4344 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004345 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004346
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004347 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004348 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004349 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4350 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4351 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4352 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4353 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004354
4355 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4356 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4357 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4358 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4359 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004360 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4361 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4362 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4363 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4364 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004365 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4366 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004367
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004368 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004369 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4370 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004371 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004372 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004373 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4374 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4375 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4376 "multipart"
4377 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4378 header
4379 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4380 and later
4381 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4382 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004383 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004384
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004385 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004386
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004387 Examples :
4388 compression algo gzip
4389 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004392cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004393 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4394 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004395 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004396 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 yes | no | yes | yes
4399 Arguments :
4400 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4401 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4402 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4403 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4404 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4405 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004406 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004407 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4408 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4409
4410 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4411 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4412 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4413 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4414 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4415 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004416 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4417 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004418 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004419 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4420 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004421
4422 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004423 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004424
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004425 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004426 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004427 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004428 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004429 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4430 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4431 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4432 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4433 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4434 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4435 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436
4437 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4438 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4439 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4440 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4441 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4442 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4443 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4444 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4445 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004446 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004447 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4448 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4449 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004450
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004451 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4452 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4453 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004454 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4455 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4456 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4457 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004458 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4459 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4460 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004461
4462 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4463 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4464 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4465 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4466 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4467 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4468 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4469 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4470 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4471
4472 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4473 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4474 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4475 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4476 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4477 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4478 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4479 persistence cookie in the cache.
4480 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4481
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004482 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4483 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4484 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4485 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4486 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004487 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004488 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4489 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4490 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4491 they logout.
4492
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004493 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4494 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4495 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4496 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4497
4498 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4499 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4500 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4501 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4502 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4503 this attribute.
4504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004505 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004506 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004507 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4508 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4509 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4510 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4511 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4512 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004513
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004514 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4515 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4516 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4517 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4518 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4519 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4520 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4521 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004522 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004523 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4524 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4525 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4526 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4527 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4528 the site.
4529
4530 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4531 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4532 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4533 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4534 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4535 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4536 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4537 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4538 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4539 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4540 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4541 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4542 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004543 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004544 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4545 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4546
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004547 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4548 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4549 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4550 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4551 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4552 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4553
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004554 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4555 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4556 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4557 repeated.
4558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004559 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4560 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4561 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4562 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004564 Examples :
4565 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4566 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4567 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004568 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004569
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004570 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004572
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004573declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4574 Declares a capture slot.
4575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4576 no | yes | yes | no
4577 Arguments:
4578 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4579
4580 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4581 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4582 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4583 for use in the response.
4584
4585 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004586 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004587 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4588
4589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004590default-server [param*]
4591 Change default options for a server in a backend
4592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | no | yes | yes
4594 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004595 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4596 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4597 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4598 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004599
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004600 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004601 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4602
4603 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004604
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606default_backend <backend>
4607 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | yes | yes | no
4610 Arguments :
4611 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4612
4613 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4614 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4615 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4616 will catch all undetermined requests.
4617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004618 Example :
4619
4620 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4621 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4622 default_backend dynamic
4623
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004624 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004626
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004627description <string>
4628 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 no | yes | yes | yes
4631 Arguments : string
4632
4633 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4634 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4635 it describes.
4636 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4637
4638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004639disabled
4640 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 yes | yes | yes | yes
4643 Arguments : none
4644
4645 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4646 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4647 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4648 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4649 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4650 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4651 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4652
4653 See also : "enabled"
4654
4655
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004656dispatch <address>:<port>
4657 Set a default server address
4658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4659 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004660 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004661
4662 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4663 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4664 during start-up.
4665
4666 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4667 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4668 possible with normal servers.
4669
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004670 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004671 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4672 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4673 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4674 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4675
4676 See also : "server"
4677
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004678
4679dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4680 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 yes | no | yes | yes
4683 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4684
4685 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004686 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004687 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4688 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004689 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004690 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004692enabled
4693 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4695 yes | yes | yes | yes
4696 Arguments : none
4697
4698 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4699 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4700
4701 See also : "disabled"
4702
4703
4704errorfile <code> <file>
4705 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | yes | yes | yes
4708 Arguments :
4709 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004710 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004711 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712
4713 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004714 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004715 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004716 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4717 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004718
4719 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4720 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4721 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4722
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004723 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4724
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004725 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4726 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4727 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4728 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4729 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4730 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4731 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4732 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4733 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4736 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4737 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004738 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4740
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004741 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004742
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004743 Example :
4744 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004745 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004746 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4747 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004749
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004750errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4751 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4752 section.
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 yes | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments :
4756 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4757
4758 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004759 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004760 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4761 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004762
4763 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4764 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4765 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4766 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4767 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004768 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004769 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4770
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004771 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4772 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004773
4774 Example :
4775 errorfiles generic
4776 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4777
4778
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004779errorloc <code> <url>
4780errorloc302 <code> <url>
4781 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4783 yes | yes | yes | yes
4784 Arguments :
4785 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004786 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004787 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004788
4789 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4790 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4791 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4792 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004793 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004794
4795 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4796 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4797 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4798
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004799 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4802 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4803 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4804 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004805 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004806 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4807 request.
4808
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004809 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004810
4811
4812errorloc303 <code> <url>
4813 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | yes | yes | yes
4816 Arguments :
4817 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004818 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004819 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004820
4821 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4822 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4823 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4824 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004825 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004826
4827 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4828 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4829 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4830
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004831 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004833 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4834 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4835 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4836 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004837 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004839 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
4841
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004842email-alert from <emailaddr>
4843 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004844 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 yes | yes | yes | yes
4847
4848 Arguments :
4849
4850 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4851
4852 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4853 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4854
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004855 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004856 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4857 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004858
4859
4860email-alert level <level>
4861 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4862 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | yes | yes | yes
4865
4866 Arguments :
4867
4868 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4869 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4870 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4871
4872 By default level is alert
4873
4874 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4875 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4876 for the proxy.
4877
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004878 Alerts are sent when :
4879
4880 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4881 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4882 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4883 is notice or lower
4884 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4885 and a health check status update occurs
4886
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004887 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4888 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004889 section 3.6 about mailers.
4890
4891
4892email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4893 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 yes | yes | yes | yes
4896
4897 Arguments :
4898
4899 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4900
4901 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4902 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4903
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004904 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4905 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004906
4907
4908email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4909 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4910 mailers.
4911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4912 yes | yes | yes | yes
4913
4914 Arguments :
4915
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004916 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004917
4918 By default the systems hostname is used.
4919
4920 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4921 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4922 for the proxy.
4923
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004924 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4925 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004926
4927
4928email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004929 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004930 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4932 yes | yes | yes | yes
4933
4934 Arguments :
4935
4936 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4937
4938 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4939 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4940
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004941 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004942 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4943
4944
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004945force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4946 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004948 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004949
4950 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4951 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4952 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4953 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4954 marked down for maintenance operations.
4955
4956 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4957 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4958 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4959 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4960 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4961 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4962 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4963 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4964 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4965
4966 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4967 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4968 is used.
4969
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004970 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004971 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004972
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004973
4974filter <name> [param*]
4975 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 no | yes | yes | yes
4978 Arguments :
4979 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4980 referenced in section 9.
4981
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004982 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004983 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004984 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4985 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004986
4987 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4988 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4989
4990 Example:
4991 listen
4992 bind *:80
4993
4994 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4995 filter compression
4996 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4997
4998 compression algo gzip
4999 compression offload
5000
5001 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5002
5003 See also : section 9.
5004
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005005
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005006fullconn <conns>
5007 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 yes | no | yes | yes
5010 Arguments :
5011 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5012 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5013
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005014 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005015 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005016 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005017 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5018 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5019 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5020 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5021 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005022 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005023
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005024 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5025 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005026 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5027 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5028 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005029
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005030 Example :
5031 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5032 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5033 # connections.
5034 backend dynamic
5035 fullconn 10000
5036 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5037 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5038
5039 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5040
5041
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005042grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005046 Arguments :
5047 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5048 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5049 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5050
5051 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5052 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005053 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005054 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5055
5056 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5057 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5058 simplify it.
5059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005060
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005061hash-balance-factor <factor>
5062 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | no | no | yes
5065 Arguments :
5066 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5067 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005068 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005069
5070 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5071 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5072 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5073 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5074 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5075 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5076 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5077
5078 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5079 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5080 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5081 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5082 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5083
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005084 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5085 consistent hashing mechanism.
5086
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005087 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5088
5089
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005090hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005091 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5093 yes | no | yes | yes
5094 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005095 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5096 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005097
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005098 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5099 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5100 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5101 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5102 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5103 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5104 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5105 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5106 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5107 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005108
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005109 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5110 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5111 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5112 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5113 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5114 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5115 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5116 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5117 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5118 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5119 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5120 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5121 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005122 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5123 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005124
5125 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5126
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005127 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005128 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5129 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5130 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005131 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5132 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5133 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005134
5135 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5136 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005137 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5138 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5139 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5140 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5141
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005142 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5143 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5144 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5145 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5146 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5147 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5148 parameter.
5149
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005150 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5151 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5152 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5153 used on strings.
5154
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005155 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5156
5157 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5158 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5159 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5160 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5161 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5162 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5163 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5164 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5165 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5166 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5167 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5168 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005169
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005170 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5171 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5172 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005173
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005174 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005175
5176
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005177http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5178 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5179 ones).
5180
5181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5182 no | yes | yes | yes
5183
5184 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5185 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5186 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5187 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5188 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5189 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5190
5191 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5192 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5193 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5194
5195 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5196 below.
5197
5198 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5199 instance.
5200
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005201 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5202 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5203 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5204
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005205 Example:
5206 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5207 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5208 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5209
5210http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5211
5212 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5213 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5214 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5215 example, or to pass some internal information.
5216 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5217 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5218 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5219
5220http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5221
5222 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5223 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5224
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005225http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005226
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005227 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5228 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5229 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5230 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5231 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005232
5233http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5234 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5235
5236 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5237
5238 Example:
5239 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5240
5241 # applied to:
5242 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5243
5244 # outputs:
5245 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5246
5247 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5248
5249http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5251
5252 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5253
5254 Example:
5255 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5256
5257 # applied to:
5258 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5259
5260 # outputs:
5261 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5262
5263http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5264
5265 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5266 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5267 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5268
5269http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5271
5272 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5273 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5274 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5275 fallback.
5276
5277 Example:
5278 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5279 http-response set-status 431
5280 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5281 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5282
5283http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5284
5285 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5286 inline.
5287
5288 Arguments:
5289 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5290 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5291 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5292 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5293 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5294 (request and response)
5295 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5296 processing
5297 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5298 processing
5299 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5300 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5301 and '_'.
5302
5303 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5304 followed by some converters.
5305
5306 Example:
5307 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5308
5309http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5310
5311 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5312 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5313 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5314 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5315 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005316 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005317 processing.
5318
5319 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5320 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005321 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005322 rules evaluation.
5323
5324http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5325
5326 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5327 details about <var-name>.
5328
5329 Example:
5330 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5331
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005332
5333http-check comment <string>
5334 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5335 it fails.
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | no | yes | yes
5338
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005339 Arguments :
5340 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5341 rule fails.
5342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005343 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5344 user-friendly error reporting.
5345
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005346 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005347 "http-check expect".
5348
5349
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005350http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5351 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005352 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | no | yes | yes
5356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005357 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005358 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5359
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005360 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005361 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005362
5363 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5364 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5365 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5366 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5367
5368 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5369
5370 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5371
5372 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5373
5374 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5375
5376 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5377
5378 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5379 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5380 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5381 is used.
5382
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005383 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5384 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5385 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5386 haproxy -vv.
5387
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005388 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5389
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005390 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5391 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5392 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5393 different ports or with different servers.
5394
5395 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5396 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5397 the port with a "http-check connect".
5398
5399 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5400 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5401 do.
5402
5403 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5404 unset-var or comment rules.
5405
5406 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005407 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5408 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5409 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5410 option httpchk
5411
5412 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005413 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005414 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005415 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005416 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005417 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005418
5419 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5420
5421 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005424http-check disable-on-404
5425 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005427 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005428 Arguments : none
5429
5430 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5431 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5432 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5433 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5434 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5435 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5436 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5437 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005438 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5439 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005440 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5441 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5442 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005443
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005444 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005445
5446
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005447http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005448 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5449 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5450 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005451 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005453 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005455 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005456 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5457
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5459 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5460 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5461 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5462 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5463 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5464 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5465 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5466 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5467 result is always conclusive.
5468
5469 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5470 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5471 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005472 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5473 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005474 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5475 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005476 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5477 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5478 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005479
5480 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5481 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005482 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5483 supported :
5484 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5485 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005486 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5487 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5488 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5489 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5490 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005491
5492 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5493 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005494 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5495 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5496 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5497 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005498 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5499
5500 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5501 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5502 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5503 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5504
5505 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5506 informational message reported in logs if an error
5507 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5508 log-format string.
5509
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005510 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005511 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5512 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005513 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5514 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5515 details on the supported keywords.
5516
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005517 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5518 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5519 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5520 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005521
5522 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5523 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5524 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5525 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5526 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5527
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005528 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5529 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5530 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5531 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5532 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5533 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5534 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005535
5536 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005537 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005538 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5539 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5540 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5541 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5542
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005543 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5544 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005545 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5546 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5547 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5548 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5549 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5550 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5551 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5552 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005553 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5554 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5555 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5556 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5557 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5558 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5559 insensitive on the header names.
5560
5561 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5562 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5563 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5564 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5565 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5566 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005567
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005568 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005569 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005570 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5571 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5572 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5573 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5574 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005575 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005576 trace).
5577
5578 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005579 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005580 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5581 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5582 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5583 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5584 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005585 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005586
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005587 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5589 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5590 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5591 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5592 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5593
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005594 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005595 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005596 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5597 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5598 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5599 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5600 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5601 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5602
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5604 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5605 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5606 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5607 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005608
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005609 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5610 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5611
5612 Examples :
5613 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005614 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005616 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5617 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5618
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005619 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005620 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621
5622 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005623 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005624
5625 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005626 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005627
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005628 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005629 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630
5631
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005632http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005633 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5634 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005635 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5636 health checks.
5637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 yes | no | yes | yes
5639 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005640 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5641
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005642 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5643 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5644 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5645 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5646 to invent non-standard ones.
5647
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005648 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5649 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5650 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5651 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5652
5653 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5654 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5655 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5656 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005657
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005658 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005659 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005660 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005661 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5662 to add it.
5663
5664 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5665 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5666 to the log-format rules.
5667
5668 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5669 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5670 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005671
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005672 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5673 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5674 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5675 request.
5676
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005677 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5678 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5679 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005680 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5681 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5682 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5683 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005684 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005685
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005686 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005687 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5688 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005689
5690 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5691 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5692 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5693 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5694 configured request authority.
5695
5696 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5697 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005698
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005699 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005700
5701
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005702http-check send-state
5703 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 yes | no | yes | yes
5706 Arguments : none
5707
5708 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5709 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5710 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5711 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5712 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5713
5714 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5715 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5716 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5717 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5718 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005719 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5720 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5721 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5722
5723 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5724 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5725 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5726
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005727 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5728 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5729 checked in multiple backends.
5730
5731 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5732 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5733
5734 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5735 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5736 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5737 one fails.
5738
5739 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5740 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5741 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5742
5743 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5744 server's queue.
5745
5746 Example of a header received by the application server :
5747 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5748 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005750 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5751 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005752
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005753
5754http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 yes | no | yes | yes
5758
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005759 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005760 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5761 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5762 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5763 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5764 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5765 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5766 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5767 and '-'.
5768
5769 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5770
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005771 Examples :
5772 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005773
5774
5775http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005776 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 yes | no | yes | yes
5779
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005780 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005781 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5782 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5783 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5784 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5785 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5786 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5787 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5788 and '-'.
5789
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005790 Examples :
5791 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005794http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5795 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5796 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5797 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5798 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 yes | yes | yes | yes
5801 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005802 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005803 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005804 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005805 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005806
5807 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5808 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5809 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5810 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5811
5812 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5813 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5814 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5815 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5816
5817 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5818 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5819 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5820 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5821 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5822 chroot is performed.
5823
5824 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5825 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5826 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5827 considered.
5828
5829 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5830 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5831 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5832 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5833 considered as a raw string.
5834
5835 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5836 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5837 "content-type".
5838
5839 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5840 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5841 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5842 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5843 evaluated as a log-format string.
5844
5845 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5846 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5847 argument to "content-type".
5848
5849 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5850 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5851 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5852 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5853
5854 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5855 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5856 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5857 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5858 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5859 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5860 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5861 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5862
5863 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5864 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5865 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5866
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005867 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5868 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5869 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5870 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5871 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5872
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005873 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5874 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5875
5876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005877http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005878 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5879
5880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 no | yes | yes | yes
5882
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005883 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5884 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5885 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5886 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5887 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005889 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5890 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 Example:
5895 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5896 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5897 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 http-request allow if nagios
5900 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5901 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5902 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904 Example:
5905 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5906 acl add path /addacl
5907 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5912 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914 Example:
5915 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5916 acl setmap path /setmap
5917 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005919 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5922 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5925 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005927http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005929 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5930 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5931 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5932 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5933 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5934 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5935 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5936 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5941 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5942 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5943 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5944 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5945 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5946 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5947 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005949http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5952 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005953
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005957 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5958 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5959 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5960 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5961 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005962
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005963 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5964 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5965 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5966 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5967 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5968 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5969 instead.
5970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971 Example:
5972 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5973 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005974
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005975http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005976
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005977 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005979http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5980 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5983 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5984 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5985 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5986 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5987 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5988 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5989 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5990 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005992 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5993 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5994 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005995 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5996
5997 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5998 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5999 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6000 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6005 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6006 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6007 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6008 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6009 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006010
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006011http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006012
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006013 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6014 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6015 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6016 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6017 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6022 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6023 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6024 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6025 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6026 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006027
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006028http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6029http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6030 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6031 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6032 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006034
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006035 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6036 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6037 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006038 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006039 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6040 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6041 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006043 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006044
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006045http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6046 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6047 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6048 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6049
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006050http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6051
6052 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6053 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6054 pointed by <resolvers>.
6055 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6056 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6057 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6058 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6059 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6060 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6061 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6062 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6063 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6064 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6065 to 0.0.0.0.
6066
6067 Example:
6068 resolvers mydns
6069 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6070 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6071 timeout retry 1s
6072 hold valid 10s
6073 hold nx 3s
6074 hold other 3s
6075 hold obsolete 0s
6076 accepted_payload_size 8192
6077
6078 frontend fe
6079 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6080 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6081 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6082
6083 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6084 # which mean DNS resolution error
6085 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6086
6087 default_backend be
6088
6089 backend b_503
6090 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6091 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6092 # 503 error page to end users
6093
6094 backend be
6095 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6096 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6097 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6098 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6099 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6100
6101 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6102 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6103
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006104http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6105
6106 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6107 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6108 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6109 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006110 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6111 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006112
6113 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6114
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006115http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006116http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006117http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006118http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006119http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006120http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6121http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006122
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006123 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6124
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006125 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6126 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6127 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6128 processing in your infrastructure.
6129
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006130 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6131 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6132 the supported backend.
6133
6134 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6135 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6136 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6137 number of segments in the path.
6138
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006139 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6140 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6141 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6142 when improperly combined.
6143
6144 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6145 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6146 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6147 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6148 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6149
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006150 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006151
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006152 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6153 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006154
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006155 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6156 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6157
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006158 Example:
6159 - /. -> /
6160 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6161 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6162 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006163
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006164 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6165 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6166
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006167 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006168 their preceding segment.
6169
6170 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6171 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6172
6173 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6174 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006175
6176 Example:
6177 - /foo/../ -> /
6178 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6179 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6180 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006181 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006182 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006183 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006184
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006185 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6186 removed as well:
6187
6188 Example:
6189 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6190 - /bar/../../ -> /
6191
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006192 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6193 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006194
6195 Example:
6196 - // -> /
6197 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6198
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006199 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6200 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6201
6202 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6203 ".", "_", and "~".
6204
6205 Example:
6206 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6207 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6208 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6209 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6210
6211 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6212 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6213
6214 Example:
6215 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6216 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6217
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006218 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006219 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006220
6221 Example:
6222 - /%6f -> /%6F
6223 - /%zz -> /%zz
6224
6225 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6226 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6227
6228 Example:
6229 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6230
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006231 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006232 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6233 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6234
6235 Example:
6236 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6237 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6238 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006240http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006242 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6243 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6244 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6245 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6246 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006248http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006250 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6251 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6252 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6253 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006255http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006257
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006258 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006259 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6260 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6261 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6262 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6263 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006264
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006265 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6266 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6267 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6268 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6269 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006270
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006271 Example:
6272 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6273
6274 # applied to:
6275 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6276
6277 # outputs:
6278 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6279
6280 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006281
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006282 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6283
6284 # applied to:
6285 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006286
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006287 # outputs:
6288 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006289
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006290http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6291 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6292
6293 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6294 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006295 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6296 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6297 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006298
6299 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6300 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6301 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6302
6303 Example:
6304 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6305 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6306
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006307 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6308 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6309 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6310 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6311
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006312http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6314
6315 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6316 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6317 query-string are replaced.
6318
6319 Example:
6320 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6321 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6322
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006323http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6325
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006326 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6327 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6328 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6329 against.
6330
6331 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6332 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6333 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006334
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006335 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6336 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6337 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6338 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6339 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6340 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6341 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6342 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6343 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006344 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6345 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006346
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006347 Example:
6348 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6349 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006350
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006351 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6352 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006354http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006356
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006357 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6358 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6359 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6360 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006361
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006362 Example:
6363 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006364
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006365 # applied to:
6366 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006367
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006368 # outputs:
6369 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006370
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006371http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6372 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6373 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006374 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6376
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006377 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006378 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6379 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006380 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006381 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006382 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006383 are followed to create the response :
6384
6385 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6386 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6387 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6388 ignored.
6389
6390 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6391 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006392 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006393 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6394 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006395
6396 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6397 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6398 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006399 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6400 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006401
6402 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6403 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6404 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006405 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006406 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006407 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006408
6409 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6410 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6411 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6412 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6413 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6414 as a raw content.
6415
6416 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6417 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6418 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6419 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6420 considered as a raw string.
6421
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006422 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006423 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6424 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6425 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6426
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006427 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6428 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006429 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006430
6431 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6432
6433 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006434 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006435 if { path /ping }
6436
6437 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6438 if { path /favicon.ico }
6439
6440 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6441 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6442 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006444http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6445http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006447 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6448 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6449 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006450
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006451http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006453
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006454 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6455 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6456 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6457 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006459http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006461 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6462 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6463 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6464 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6465 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006467 Arguments:
6468 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6469 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006471 Example:
6472 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6473 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006475 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6476 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006480 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6481 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6482 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006484 Arguments:
6485 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6486 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006488 Example:
6489 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6490 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006492 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6493 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6494 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6499 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6500 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6501 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6502 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006504 Example:
6505 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6506 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6507 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6508 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6509 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6510 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6511 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6512 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6513 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006515http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6518 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6519 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6520 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6521 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006523http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6524 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6527 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6528 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6529 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6530 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6531 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6532 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6533 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6534 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006536http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6539 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6540 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6541 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6542 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6543 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6544 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006546http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6549 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6550 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006552http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006554 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6555 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6556 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6557 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6558 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6559 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6560 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6561 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006565 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6566 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6567 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6568 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6569 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6570 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 Example :
6573 # prepend the host name before the path
6574 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006575
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006576http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6577
6578 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6579 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6580 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6585 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6586 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6587 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6588 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6593 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6594 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6595 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6596 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6597 values have higher priority.
6598 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6599 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6600 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6601 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6602 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6607 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6608 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6609 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6610 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6611 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6612 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006615
6616 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6618 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6621 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6622 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6623 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006624 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6625 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626
6627 Arguments :
6628 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6629 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006630
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006631 See also "option forwardfor".
6632
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006633 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6635 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6636
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006637 # After the masking this will track connections
6638 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6639 http-request track-sc0 src
6640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006641 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6642 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6643
6644http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6645
6646 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6647 expression.
6648
6649 Arguments:
6650 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6651 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006652
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006653 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6655 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6656
6657 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6658 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6659 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6660
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006661http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006662 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6663
6664 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6665 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6666 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6667 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6668 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6669
6670 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6671 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6672 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6673 results.
6674
6675 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006676 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6677 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6680
6681 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6682 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6683 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6684 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6685 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6686 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6687 information from the request.
6688
6689 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6690
6691http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6692
6693 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6694 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6695 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6696 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6697 path and the query string.
6698 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6699
6700http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6701
6702 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6703 inline.
6704
6705 Arguments:
6706 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6707 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6708 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6709 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6710 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6711 (request and response)
6712 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6713 processing
6714 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6715 processing
6716 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6717 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6718 and '_'.
6719
6720 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6721 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006722
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006723 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6727 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6730 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6731 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6732 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6733 agent name must be used.
6734
6735 Arguments:
6736 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6737
6738 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6739 configuration.
6740
6741http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6742
6743 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6744 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6745 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6746 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6747 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6748 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6749 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6750 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6751 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6752 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6753 action.
6754 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6755 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6756 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6757 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6758 you fully understand how it works.
6759
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006760http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6761
6762 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6763 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6764 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6765 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6766 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006767 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006768 processing.
6769
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006770 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006771 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6772 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6773 rules evaluation.
6774
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006775http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6776http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6777 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6778 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6779 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6780 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781
6782 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6783 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6784 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006785 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6786 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6787 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6788 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6789 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6790 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6791 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6792 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6793 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6794 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006795 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006796 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6797 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6798 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6799 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6800 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006801
6802http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6803http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6804http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6805
6806 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6807 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6808 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6809 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006810 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6812 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6813 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6814 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6815 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6816 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6817 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6818
6819 Arguments :
6820 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6821 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6822 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6823 select which table entry to update the counters.
6824
6825 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6826 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6827 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6828 that table until the session ends.
6829
6830 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6831 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6832 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6833 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6834 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6835 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6836 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6837 useful information.
6838
6839 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6840 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6841 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6842 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6843 checks that make use of it.
6844
6845http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846
6847 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006848
6849 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006850 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006852http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6855 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6856 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6857 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6858 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6859 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6860
6861 Arguments :
6862 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6863
6864 Example:
6865 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6866
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006867http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6868 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6869
6870 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6871 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6872 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6873 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6874 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6875 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6876 http-buffer-request".
6877
6878 Arguments :
6879
6880 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6881 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6882
6883 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006884 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006885 bytes.
6886
6887 Example:
6888 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6889
6890 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006892http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006894 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6895 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6896 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006897
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006899http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006900 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6901
6902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 no | yes | yes | yes
6904
6905 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6906 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6907 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6908 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6909 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6910 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6911
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006912 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6913 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006915 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006917 Example:
6918 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006920 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006922 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6923 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006925 Example:
6926 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006928 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006930 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6931 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006933 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6934 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006936http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006938 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6939 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6940 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6941 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6942 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6943 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6944 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6945 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6950 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6951 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6952 example, or to pass some internal information.
6953 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6954 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6955 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006957http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006959 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6960 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006961
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006962http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006963
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006964 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006966http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6969 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6970 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6971 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6972 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6973 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6974 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6977 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6978 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6979 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6980 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006981
6982 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6983 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6984 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6985 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006987http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006989 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6990 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6991 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6992 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6993 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6994 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006995
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006996http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006997
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006998 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6999 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7000 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7001 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7002 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007004http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007006 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7007 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7008 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7009 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7010 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7011 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007012
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007013http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7014http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7015 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7016 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7017 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7018 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007019
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7021 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7022 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007023 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007024 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7025 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7026 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007027 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007028 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007030http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007032 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7033 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7034 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7035 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7036 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7037 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7040 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007041
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007042 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7043 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 Example:
7046 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 # applied to:
7049 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 # outputs:
7052 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7057 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007058
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007059 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007060 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007062 Example:
7063 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 # applied to:
7066 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 # outputs:
7069 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007070
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007071http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7072 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7073 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007074 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007075 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7076
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007077 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007078 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7079 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007080 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007081 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007082 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007083 are followed to create the response :
7084
7085 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7086 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7087 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7088 ignored.
7089
7090 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7091 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007092 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007093 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7094 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007095
7096 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7097 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7098 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007099 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7100 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007101
7102 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7103 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7104 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007105 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007106 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007107 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007108
7109 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7110 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7111 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7112 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7113 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7114 as a raw content.
7115
7116 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7117 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7118 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7119 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7120 considered as a raw string.
7121
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007122 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7123 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7124 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7125 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7126
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007127 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7128 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007129 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007130
7131 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7132
7133 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007134 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007135 if { status eq 404 }
7136
7137 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7138 string "This is the end !" \
7139 if { status eq 500 }
7140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7142http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007144 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7145 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7146 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007147
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007148http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007150
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007151 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7152 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7153 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7154 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007156http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007158 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7159 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7160 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7161 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7162 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007164 Arguments:
7165 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7168 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007170http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7173 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7174 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7177
7178 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7179 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7180 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7181 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7182 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7183
7184http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7185
7186 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7187 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7188 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7189 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7190 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7191 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7192 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7193 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7194 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7195
7196http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7197
7198 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7199 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7200 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7201 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7202 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7203 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7204 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7205
7206http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7207
7208 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7209 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7210 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7211 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7212 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7213 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7214 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7215 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7216
7217http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7218 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7219
7220 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7221 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7222 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7223 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007224
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007225 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007226 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7227 http-response set-status 431
7228 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7229 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007231http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007233 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7234 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7235 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7236 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7237 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7238 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7239 based on some information from the request.
7240
7241 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7242
7243http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7244
7245 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7246 inline.
7247
7248 Arguments:
7249 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7250 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7254 (request and response)
7255 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7256 processing
7257 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7258 processing
7259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7260 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7261 and '_'.
7262
7263 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7264 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007265
7266 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007267 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007271 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7272 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7273 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7274 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7275 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7276 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7277 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7278 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7279 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7280 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7281 action.
7282 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7283 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7284 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7285 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7286 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007287
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007288http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7289
7290 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7291 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7292 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7293 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7294 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007295 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007296 processing.
7297
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007298 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007299 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007300 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007301 rules evaluation.
7302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007303http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7304http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7305http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007307 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7308 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7309 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7310 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7311 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7312 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7313
7314http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7315
7316 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7317 about <var-name>.
7318
7319 Example:
7320 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7321
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007322http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7326 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7327 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7328 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7329 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7330 buffer is full.
7331
7332 Arguments :
7333
7334 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7335 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7336
7337 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007338 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007339 bytes.
7340
7341 Example:
7342 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007343
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007344http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7345 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7346
7347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 yes | no | yes | yes
7349
7350 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007351 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7352 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7353 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007354
7355 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7356
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007357 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7358 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7359 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7360 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7361 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7362 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7363 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7364 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7365 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7366 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007367
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007368 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7369 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7370 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7371 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7372 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7373 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7374 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007375 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7376 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7377 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7378 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7379 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7380 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007381
7382 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7383 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7384 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7385 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7386 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7387 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7388 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7389 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007390 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007391 downsides of rare connection failures.
7392
7393 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7394 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7395 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7396 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7397 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7398 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007399 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007400 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7401 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7402 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7403 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7404 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7405
7406 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007407 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7408 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7409 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7410 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007411
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007412 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7413 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007414
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007415 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007416
7417 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7418 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7419 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7420
7421 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7422
7423
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007424http-send-name-header [<header>]
7425 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7427 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007428 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007429 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7430
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007431 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7432 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7433 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7434 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7435 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7436 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7437 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7438 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7439 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7440 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7441 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7442 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7443 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7444 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7445 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7446 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007447
7448 See also : "server"
7449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007450id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007451 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7453 no | yes | yes | yes
7454 Arguments : none
7455
7456 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7457 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7458 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007459
7460
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007461ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7462 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007464 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007465
7466 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7467 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7468 and running).
7469
7470 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7471 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7472 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007473 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007474 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7475
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007476 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7477 "unless" condition is met.
7478
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007479 Example:
7480 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7481 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7482 ignore-persist if url_static
7483
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007484 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7485
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007486load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7487 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7489 yes | no | yes | yes
7490
7491 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7492 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7493 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007495 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7496 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7497 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7498 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7499
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007500 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007501 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007502 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007503
7504 Arguments:
7505 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7506 named "server-state-file".
7507
7508 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7509 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7510 name is used as a file name.
7511
7512 none don't load any stat for this backend
7513
7514 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007515 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7516 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7517 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007518 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007519 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007520
7521 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7522 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7523
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007524 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007526 global
7527 stats socket /tmp/socket
7528 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007529
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007530 defaults
7531 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007532
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007533 backend bk
7534 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7535 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007536
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007537
7538 Then one can run :
7539
7540 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7541
7542 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7543
7544 1
7545 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7546 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7547 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7548
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007549 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007550
7551 global
7552 stats socket /tmp/socket
7553 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7554
7555 defaults
7556 load-server-state-from-file local
7557
7558 backend bk
7559 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7560 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7561
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007562
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007563 Then one can run :
7564
7565 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7566
7567 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7568
7569 1
7570 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7571 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7572 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7573
7574 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7575 "show servers state"
7576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007578log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007579log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007580 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007581no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007582 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007585
7586 Prefix :
7587 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7588 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7589 prefix does not allow arguments.
7590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007591 Arguments :
7592 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7593 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7594 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7595 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7596 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7597 parameter.
7598
7599 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7600 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7601
7602 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7603 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7604 standard syslog port).
7605
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007606 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7607 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7608 standard syslog port).
7609
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007610 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7611 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7612 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007613 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007614
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007615 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7616 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7617 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7618 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7619 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7620 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7621 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7622 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7623 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7624 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7625 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7626 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7627 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7628 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7629 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7630 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007631 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7632 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007633
7634 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7635 and "fd@2", see above.
7636
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007637 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7638 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7639 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7640 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7641 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7642 having the logs instantly available.
7643
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007644 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7645 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7646 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7647
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7649 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007650
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007651 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7652 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7653 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7654 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7655 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7656 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7657 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7658 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7659 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7660 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007661 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007662
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007663 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7664 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7665 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7666 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7667 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7668
7669 <sample_size>
7670 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7671 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7672 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7673 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7674 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7675
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007676 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7677 one of the following :
7678
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007679 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7680 field is stripped. This is the default.
7681 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7682 rfc3164.
7683
7684 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007685 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7686
7687 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7688 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7689
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007690 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7691 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7692 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7693 designed to be used with a local log server.
7694
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007695 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7696 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7697 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7698 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7699 systemd logger consumes.
7700
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007701 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7702 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7703 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7704 used with a local log server.
7705
7706 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7707 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7708 designed to be used with a local log server.
7709
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007710 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7711 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7712 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7713 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007715 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7716
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007717 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7718 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7719 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7720
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007721 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7722 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7723 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7724 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007725
7726 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7727 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7728 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007729 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7730 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7731 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7732 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7733 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007734
7735 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7736
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007737 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7738 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7739 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007740
7741 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7742 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7743 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7744 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7745
7746 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7747 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007748
7749 Example :
7750 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007751 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7752 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7753 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007754 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007755 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7756 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007757 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007758
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007759
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007760log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007761 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7763 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007764
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007765 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7766 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7767 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7768 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7769 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007770
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007771 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7772 "option httplog" directives.
7773
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007774log-format-sd <string>
7775 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7777 yes | yes | yes | no
7778
7779 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7780 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7781 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7782 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7783 which covers the log format string in depth.
7784
7785 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7786 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7787
7788 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7789 log format to "rfc5424".
7790
7791 Example :
7792 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7793
7794
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007795log-tag <string>
7796 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7798 yes | yes | yes | yes
7799
7800 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7801 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7802 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7803 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7804 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7805 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7806 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7807 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7808 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007809
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007810max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7811 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7813 yes | no | yes | yes
7814
7815 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7816 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7817 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7818 servers.
7819
7820 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7821 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7822 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7823 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7824 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007825 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007826 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7827 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7828 picking a different server.
7829
7830 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7831 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7832 even if they have to be queued.
7833
7834 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7835 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7836
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007837max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7838 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7839 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7840 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007841
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007842maxconn <conns>
7843 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | yes | yes | no
7846 Arguments :
7847 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7848 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7849 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7850 closes.
7851
7852 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7853 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7854 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7855 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007856 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7857 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7858 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7859 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007860
7861 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7862 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7863 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7864
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007865 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7866 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007867
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007868 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7869
7870
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007871mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007872 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 yes | yes | yes | yes
7875 Arguments :
7876 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7877 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7878 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7879 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7880
7881 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7882 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7883 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7884 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7885 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7886
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007887 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7888 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7889 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007891 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007892 defaults http_instances
7893 mode http
7894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007895
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007896monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007897 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007900 Arguments :
7901 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7902 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007903 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007904 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7905 backend and its backup.
7906
7907 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7908 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7909 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7910 servers in a list of backends.
7911
7912 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7913 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7914 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7915 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7916 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7917 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7918 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007919 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7920 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007921
7922 Example:
7923 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007925 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7926 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7927 monitor-uri /site_alive
7928 monitor fail if site_dead
7929
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007930 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007931
7932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007933monitor-uri <uri>
7934 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | yes | yes | no
7937 Arguments :
7938 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7939 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7940
7941 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7942 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7943 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7944 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7945 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7946 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7947 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7948 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7949
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007950 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007951 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7952 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7953 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7954 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7955 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7956 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007957
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007958 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7959 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7960 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7961 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7962
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007963 Example :
7964 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7965 frontend www
7966 mode http
7967 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7968
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007969 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007972option abortonclose
7973no option abortonclose
7974 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | no | yes | yes
7977 Arguments : none
7978
7979 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7980 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7981 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7982 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007983 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007984 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7985 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7986 encountered while delivering the response.
7987
7988 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7989 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7990 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7991 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7992 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7993 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007994 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007995 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007996 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007997 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7998 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7999 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8002 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008003 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8004 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8005 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8006 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8007 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8008 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008009 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008010
8011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8013
8014 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8015
8016
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008017option accept-invalid-http-request
8018no option accept-invalid-http-request
8019 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | yes | yes | no
8022 Arguments : none
8023
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008024 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008025 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008026 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008027 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8028 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8029 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8030 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8031 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008032 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8033 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8034 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8035 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008036 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008037 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008038 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8039 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8040 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008041
8042 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8043 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8044 been confirmed.
8045
8046 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8047 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008048 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8049 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008050 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8051
8052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8054
8055 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8056 stats socket.
8057
8058
8059option accept-invalid-http-response
8060no option accept-invalid-http-response
8061 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | no | yes | yes
8064 Arguments : none
8065
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008066 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008067 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008068 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008069 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8070 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8071 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8072 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8073 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008074 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8075 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8076 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008077
8078 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8079 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8080 been confirmed.
8081
8082 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8083 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8084 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8085 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8086
8087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8089
8090 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8091 stats socket.
8092
8093
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008094option allbackups
8095no option allbackups
8096 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | no | yes | yes
8099 Arguments : none
8100
8101 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8102 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8103 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8104 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8105 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8106 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8107 order between the backup servers anymore.
8108
8109 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8110 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8111
8112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8114
8115
8116option checkcache
8117no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008118 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
8121 Arguments : none
8122
8123 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8124 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008125 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008126 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8127 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008128 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008129
8130 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008131 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008132 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008133 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8134 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008135 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008136 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008137 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8138 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008139 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008140 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8141 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008142 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008143 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8144 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8145 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8146 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8147 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8148 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8149 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8150 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8151 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8152
8153 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008154 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8155 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8156 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8157 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008158
8159 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8160 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008161 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008162 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008163
8164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8166
8167
8168option clitcpka
8169no option clitcpka
8170 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 yes | yes | yes | no
8173 Arguments : none
8174
8175 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8176 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008177 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008178 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8179
8180 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8181 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8182 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8183 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8184
8185 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8186 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8187 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8188 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8189 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8190
8191 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8192
8193 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8194 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8195 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8196
8197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8199
8200 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8201
8202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008203option contstats
8204 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8206 yes | yes | yes | no
8207 Arguments : none
8208
8209 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8210 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8211 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8212 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008213 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8214 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8215 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8216 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8217 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008218
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008219option disable-h2-upgrade
8220no option disable-h2-upgrade
8221 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8222 connection.
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8224 yes | yes | yes | no
8225 Arguments : none
8226
8227 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8228 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8229 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8230 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008231 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8232 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8233 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8234 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8235 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8236 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008237
8238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008240
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008241option dontlog-normal
8242no option dontlog-normal
8243 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 yes | yes | yes | no
8246 Arguments : none
8247
8248 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8249 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8250 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8251 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8252 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8253 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8254 logged.
8255
8256 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8257 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8258 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008260 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008261 logging.
8262
8263
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008264option dontlognull
8265no option dontlognull
8266 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8268 yes | yes | yes | no
8269 Arguments : none
8270
8271 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8272 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8273 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8274 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8275 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8276 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008277 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8278 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8279 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008280
8281 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008282 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008283 would not be logged.
8284
8285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8287
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008288 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008289 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008290
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008291
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008292option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008293 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8295 yes | yes | yes | yes
8296 Arguments :
8297 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8298 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008299 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008300 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008301
8302 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8303 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8304 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8305 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8306 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8307 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8308 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008309 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8310 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8311 possible that the client has already brought one.
8312
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008313 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008314 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008315 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008316 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008317 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008318 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008319
8320 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8321 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8322 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8323 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8324 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8325 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008326 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008327
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008328 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8329 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8330 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8331 are under the control of the end-user.
8332
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008333 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008334 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8335 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008336 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8337 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8338 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008339
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008340 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008341 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8342 frontend www
8343 mode http
8344 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8345
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008346 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8347 backend www
8348 mode http
8349 option forwardfor header X-Client
8350
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008351 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008352 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008353
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008354
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008355option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8356no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8357 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8359 yes | yes | yes | no
8360 Arguments : none
8361
8362 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8363 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8364 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8365 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8366 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8367 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8368 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8369
8370 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8371 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8372 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8373 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8374 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8375 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8376 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8377 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8378 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8379 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8380
8381 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8382
8383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8385
8386 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8387 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8388
8389
8390option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8391no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8392 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8394 yes | no | yes | yes
8395 Arguments : none
8396
8397 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8398 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8399 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8400 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8401 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8402 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8403 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8404
8405 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8406 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8407 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8408 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8409 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8410 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8411 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8412 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8413 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8414 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8415
8416 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8417
8418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8420
8421 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8422 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8423
8424
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008425option http-buffer-request
8426no option http-buffer-request
8427 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8429 yes | yes | yes | yes
8430 Arguments : none
8431
8432 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8433 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8434 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8435 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8436 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8437 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008438 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8439 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8440 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8441 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008442
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008443 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8444 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008445
8446
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008447option http-ignore-probes
8448no option http-ignore-probes
8449 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | yes | yes | no
8452 Arguments : none
8453
8454 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8455 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8456 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8457 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8458 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8459 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8460 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8461 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8462 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008463 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8464 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008465 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8466
8467 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8468 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8469 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8470 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8471 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8472 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8473 are often the only way to detect them.
8474
8475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8477
8478 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8479
8480
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008481option http-keep-alive
8482no option http-keep-alive
8483 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 yes | yes | yes | yes
8486 Arguments : none
8487
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008488 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8489 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008490 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8491 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008492 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8493 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8494 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008495
8496 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8497 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008498 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8499 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8500 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8501 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8502 situations where this option may be useful :
8503
8504 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008505 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008506
8507 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8508 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8509
8510 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8511 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8512 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8513 request.
8514
8515 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8516 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008517 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8518 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8519 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008520
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008521 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8522 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8523 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8524 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8525 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8526 not set.
8527
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008528 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8529 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8530 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008531
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008532 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008533 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008534 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008535
8536
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008537option http-no-delay
8538no option http-no-delay
8539 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | yes
8542 Arguments : none
8543
8544 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8545 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8546 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8547 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8548 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8549 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8550 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8551 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8552 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8553 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8554 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8555 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8556 affected.
8557
8558 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8559 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8560 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8561 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8562 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8563 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8564 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8565 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8566 latency environments.
8567
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008568 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8569
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008570
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008571option http-pretend-keepalive
8572no option http-pretend-keepalive
8573 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008575 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008576 Arguments : none
8577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008578 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008579 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8580 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8581 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8582 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8583 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8584 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8585 consider the response complete.
8586
8587 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8588 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8589 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8590 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008591 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008592 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8593
8594 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8595 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8596 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8597 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8598 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8599 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8600 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8601
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008602 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8603 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8604 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8605 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8606 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8607 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008608
8609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8611
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008612 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008613 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008614
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008615
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008616option http-server-close
8617no option http-server-close
8618 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8620 yes | yes | yes | yes
8621 Arguments : none
8622
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008623 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8624 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8625 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8626 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008627 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8628 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8629 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8630 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8631 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8632 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8633 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8634 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8635 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8636 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8637 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008638
8639 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8640 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8641 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8642 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008643 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8644 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008645
8646 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8647 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008648 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8649 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8650 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008651
8652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8654
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008655 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8656 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008657
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008658option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008659no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008660 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8662 yes | yes | yes | no
8663 Arguments : none
8664
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008665 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008666 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8667 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8668 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8669 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8670 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8671 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8672
8673 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8674 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008675 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8676 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8677 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008678
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008679 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8680 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8681 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8682 front of an existing proxy.
8683
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008684 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8685
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008686 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008687
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688option httpchk
8689option httpchk <uri>
8690option httpchk <method> <uri>
8691option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008692 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | no | yes | yes
8695 Arguments :
8696 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8697 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8698 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8699 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8700 ones.
8701
8702 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8703 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8704 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8705
8706 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8707 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8708 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008709 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008710
8711 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8712 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8713 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8714 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8715 the lack of any response.
8716
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008717 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8718 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8719 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8720 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8721
8722 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8723 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8724 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008725
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008726 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8727 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008728 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008729 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008730 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008731
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008732 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8733 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8734 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8735 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8736
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008737 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008738 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8739 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8740 backend https_relay
8741 mode tcp
8742 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8743 http-check send hdr Host www
8744 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008745
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008746 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8747 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8748 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008749
8750
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008751option httpclose
8752no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008753 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8755 yes | yes | yes | yes
8756 Arguments : none
8757
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008758 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8759 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8760 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8761 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008762 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008763
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008764 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8765 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008766 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008767 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8768 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008769
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008770 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8771 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8772 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008773
8774 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8775 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008776 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8777 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8778 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008779
8780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8782
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008783 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008784
8785
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008786option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008787 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008789 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008790 Arguments :
8791 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8792 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8793 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008794 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008795 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008796
8797 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8798 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8799 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8800 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8801 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8802 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8803 ports.
8804
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008805 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8806 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008807
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008808 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008810 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008811
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008812
8813option http_proxy
8814no option http_proxy
8815 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 yes | yes | yes | yes
8818 Arguments : none
8819
8820 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8821 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8822 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8823 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8824 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8825
8826 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8827 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008828 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8829 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008830
8831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8833
8834 Example :
8835 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8836 backend direct_forward
8837 option httpclose
8838 option http_proxy
8839
8840 See also : "option httpclose"
8841
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008842
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008843option independent-streams
8844no option independent-streams
8845 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8847 yes | yes | yes | yes
8848 Arguments : none
8849
8850 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8851 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8852 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8853 receive data or not.
8854
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008855 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008856 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8857 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8858 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8859 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8860 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8861 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8862 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8863 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8864 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8865 socket buffers.
8866
8867 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8868 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8869 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8870 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8871 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8872
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008873 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008874
8875
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008876option ldap-check
8877 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8879 yes | no | yes | yes
8880 Arguments : none
8881
8882 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8883 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8884 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8885 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8886
8887 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8888 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8889
8890 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8891 configure it.
8892
8893 Example :
8894 option ldap-check
8895
8896 See also : "option httpchk"
8897
8898
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008899option external-check
8900 Use external processes for server health checks
8901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8902 yes | no | yes | yes
8903
8904 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8905 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8906 command".
8907
8908 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8909
8910 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8911
8912
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008913option log-health-checks
8914no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008915 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8917 yes | no | yes | yes
8918 Arguments : none
8919
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008920 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8921 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8922 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008923
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008924 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8925 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8926 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8927 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8928 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8929
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008930 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008931 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008932
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008933 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8934 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8935 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008936
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008937
8938option log-separate-errors
8939no option log-separate-errors
8940 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8942 yes | yes | yes | no
8943 Arguments : none
8944
8945 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8946 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8947 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8948 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8949 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8950 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8951 provides very important information.
8952
8953 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8954 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8955 error logs.
8956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008957 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008958 logging.
8959
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008960
8961option logasap
8962no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008963 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8965 yes | yes | yes | no
8966 Arguments : none
8967
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008968 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8969 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8970 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8971 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8972
8973 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8974 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8975 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8976 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8977 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008978 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008979 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8980 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8981 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8982 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008983 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008985 Examples :
8986 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8987 mode http
8988 option httplog
8989 option logasap
8990 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8991
8992 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8993 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8994 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8995 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008998 logging.
8999
9000
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009001option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009002 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009005 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009006 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9007 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009008 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9009 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009010
9011 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9012 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009013 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009014 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9015 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9016 in the MySQL table, like this :
9017
9018 USE mysql;
9019 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9020 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9021
9022 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009023 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009024 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9025 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9026 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9027 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9028 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9029 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9030 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9031
9032 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9033 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009034
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009035 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009036
9037 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9038 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9039 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9040 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009041 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9042 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009043
9044 See also: "option httpchk"
9045
9046
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009047option nolinger
9048no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009049 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009052 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009053
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009054 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009055 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9056 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9057 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9058 connections.
9059
9060 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9061 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009062 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9063 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9064 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9065 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9066 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9067 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9068 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9069 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9070 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9071 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9072 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9073 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9074 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009075
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009076 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9077 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9078 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9079 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9080 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009081
9082 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9083 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009084 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009085 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009086 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009087
9088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9090
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009091 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9092 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009093
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009094option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9095 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | yes | yes | yes
9098 Arguments :
9099 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9100 matching <network>
9101 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9102 header name.
9103
9104 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9105 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9106 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9107 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9108 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9109 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9110 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9111 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9112 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9113 possible that the client has already brought one.
9114
9115 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9116 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9117 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9118 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9119 header and requires different one.
9120
9121 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9122 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9123 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009124 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9125 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9126 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9127 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9128 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009129
9130 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9131 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9132 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9133 both are defined.
9134
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009135 Examples :
9136 # Original Destination address
9137 frontend www
9138 mode http
9139 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9140
9141 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9142 backend www
9143 mode http
9144 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9145
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009146 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009147
9148
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009149option persist
9150no option persist
9151 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9153 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009154 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009155
9156 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9157 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9158 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9159 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9160 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9161 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9162 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9163 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9164 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9165 redirected to another valid server.
9166
9167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9169
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009170 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009171
9172
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009173option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9174 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9176 yes | no | yes | yes
9177 Arguments :
9178 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9179 PostgreSQL server.
9180
9181 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9182 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9183 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9184 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9185
9186 See also: "option httpchk"
9187
9188
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009189option prefer-last-server
9190no option prefer-last-server
9191 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9192 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 yes | no | yes | yes
9194 Arguments : none
9195
9196 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9197 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9198 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9199 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9200 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9201 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9202 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9203 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9204 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009205 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9206 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009207 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9208 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9209 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009210 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9211 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9212 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009213
9214 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9215 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9216
9217 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9218
9219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009220option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009221option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009222no option redispatch
9223 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009226 Arguments :
9227 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9228 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9229 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009230 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009231 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009232 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009233 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9234 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9235 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009237
9238 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9239 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9240 be able to access the service anymore.
9241
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009242 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9243 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009244
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009245 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9246 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9247 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9248 following order:
9249
9250 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9251
9252 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9253 list, or
9254
9255 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9256
9257 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9258 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9259
9260 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9261 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9262 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9263 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9264
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009265 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009266 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9267 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9271
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009272 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009273
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009274
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009275option redis-check
9276 Use redis health checks for server testing
9277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | no | yes | yes
9279 Arguments : none
9280
9281 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9282 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9283 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9284 find the "+PONG" response message.
9285
9286 Example :
9287 option redis-check
9288
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009289 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009290
9291
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009292option smtpchk
9293option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9294 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9296 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009298 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009299 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009300 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9301
9302 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9303 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9304 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9305
9306 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9307 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9308 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9309 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9310 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9311 dead server.
9312
9313 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9314 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009315 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009316 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9317
9318 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9319 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9320 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9321 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009322 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009323
9324 Example :
9325 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9326
9327 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009330option socket-stats
9331no option socket-stats
9332
9333 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9335 yes | yes | yes | no
9336
9337 Arguments : none
9338
9339
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009340option splice-auto
9341no option splice-auto
9342 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9344 yes | yes | yes | yes
9345 Arguments : none
9346
9347 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9348 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009350 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009351 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009352 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9353 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9354 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9355 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9356
9357 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9358 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9359 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9360 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9361 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9362 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9363 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9364 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9365 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9366 keyword.
9367
9368 Example :
9369 option splice-auto
9370
9371 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9372 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9373
9374 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9375 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9376
9377
9378option splice-request
9379no option splice-request
9380 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9382 yes | yes | yes | yes
9383 Arguments : none
9384
9385 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009386 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009387 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9388 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9389 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9390 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9391
9392 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9393
9394 Example :
9395 option splice-request
9396
9397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9399
9400 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9401 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9402
9403
9404option splice-response
9405no option splice-response
9406 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9408 yes | yes | yes | yes
9409 Arguments : none
9410
9411 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009412 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009413 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9414 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9415 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9416 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9417
9418 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9419
9420 Example :
9421 option splice-response
9422
9423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9425
9426 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9427 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9428
9429
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009430option spop-check
9431 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9433 no | no | no | yes
9434 Arguments : none
9435
9436 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9437 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9438 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9439 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9440
9441 Example :
9442 option spop-check
9443
9444 See also : "option httpchk"
9445
9446
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009447option srvtcpka
9448no option srvtcpka
9449 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9451 yes | no | yes | yes
9452 Arguments : none
9453
9454 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9455 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009456 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009457 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9458
9459 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9460 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9461 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9462 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9463
9464 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9465 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9466 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9467 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9468 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9469
9470 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9471
9472 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9473 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9474 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9475
9476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9478
9479 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9480
9481
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009482option ssl-hello-chk
9483 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 yes | no | yes | yes
9486 Arguments : none
9487
9488 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9489 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9490 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9491 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9492 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9493 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9494 hello message.
9495
9496 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9497 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9498 messages, which is appreciable.
9499
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009500 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9501 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9502 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009503
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009504 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9505
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009506
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009507option tcp-check
9508 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | no | yes | yes
9511
9512 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9513 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9514
9515 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9516 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9517 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9518
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009519 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009520 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9521 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9522 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9523 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9524 only.
9525
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009526 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009527 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9528 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9529 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9530 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9531
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009532 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9534 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009535 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009536 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9537 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9538 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9539 the respective protocols.
9540 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009541 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009542
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009543 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009544
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009545 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9546 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9547 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9548 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009549
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009550 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9551 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9552 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009553
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009554
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009555 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009556 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009557 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009558 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009560 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009561 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009562 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009563
9564 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9565 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009567 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009568 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009569 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009570 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009571 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9573 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009574 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009575 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9576 tcp-check expect string +OK
9577
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009579 (send many headers before analyzing)
9580 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009581 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009582 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9583 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9584 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9585 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009586 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009587
9588
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009589 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009590
9591
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009592option tcp-smart-accept
9593no option tcp-smart-accept
9594 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 yes | yes | yes | no
9597 Arguments : none
9598
9599 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9600 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9601 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9602 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9603 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9604 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9605
9606 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9607 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9608 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9609 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9610
9611 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9612 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9613 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009614 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009615
9616 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9617 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9618 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9619
9620 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9621 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9622 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9623
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009624 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9625
9626
9627option tcp-smart-connect
9628no option tcp-smart-connect
9629 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9631 yes | no | yes | yes
9632 Arguments : none
9633
9634 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9635 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9636 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9637 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9638 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9639
9640 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9641 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9642 complex.
9643
9644 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9645 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9646 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9647
9648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9650
9651 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9652
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009654option tcpka
9655 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9657 yes | yes | yes | yes
9658 Arguments : none
9659
9660 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9661 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009662 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009663 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9664
9665 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9666 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9667 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9668 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9669
9670 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9671 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9672 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9673 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9674 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9675
9676 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9677
9678 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9679 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9680 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9681 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9682 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9683 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9684 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9685 backends.
9686
9687 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9688
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009689
9690option tcplog
9691 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009693 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009694 Arguments : none
9695
9696 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9697 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9698 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9699 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9700 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9701 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9702 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9703 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9704
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009705 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009707 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009708
9709
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009710option transparent
9711no option transparent
9712 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009714 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009715 Arguments : none
9716
9717 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9718 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9719 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9720 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9721 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9722 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9723 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9724 appropriate server.
9725
9726 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9727 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9728
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009729 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009730 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009731
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009732
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009733external-check command <command>
9734 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9736 yes | no | yes | yes
9737
9738 Arguments :
9739 <command> is the external command to run
9740
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009741 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9742
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009743 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009744
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009745 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9746 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9747 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9748 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9749 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9750 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009751
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009752 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9753
9754 Environment variables :
9755 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9756 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9757
9758 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9759
9760 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9761
9762 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9763 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9764 for a UNIX socket).
9765
9766 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9767
9768 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9769
9770 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9771
9772 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9773
9774 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9775
9776 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9777 socket).
9778
9779 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9780 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9781
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009782 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9783
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009784 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9785 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9786 failed.
9787
9788 Example :
9789 external-check command /bin/true
9790
9791 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9792
9793
9794external-check path <path>
9795 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9797 yes | no | yes | yes
9798
9799 Arguments :
9800 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9801
9802 The default path is "".
9803
9804 Example :
9805 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9806
9807 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9808 "external-check command"
9809
9810
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009811persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009812persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009813 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9815 yes | no | yes | yes
9816 Arguments :
9817 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009818 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9819 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009820
9821 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9822 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009823 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009824 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9825 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9826 forwarded to this server.
9827
9828 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9829 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9830 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009831 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009832 a single "listen" section.
9833
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009834 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9835 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9836 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9837
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009838 Example :
9839 listen tse-farm
9840 bind :3389
9841 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9842 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9843 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9844 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9845 persist rdp-cookie
9846 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009847 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009848 balance rdp-cookie
9849 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9850 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9851
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009852 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9853 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009854
9855
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009856rate-limit sessions <rate>
9857 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9859 yes | yes | yes | no
9860 Arguments :
9861 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9862 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9863
9864 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9865 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9866 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9867 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9868 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9869 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9870
9871 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9872 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9873 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9874 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9875
9876 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9877 listen smtp
9878 mode tcp
9879 bind :25
9880 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009881 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009882
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009883 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9884 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9885 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009886
9887 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9888
9889
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009890redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9891redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9892redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009893 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9895 no | yes | yes | yes
9896
9897 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009898 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009899
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009901 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009902 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9903 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9904 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009905
9906 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9907 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9908 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9909 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9910 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009911 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9912 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9913 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9914 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009915
9916 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9917 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9918 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9919 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9920 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9921 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009922 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009923 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009924 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9925 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9926 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009927
9928 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009929 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9930 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9931 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009932 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009933 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9934 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9935 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9936 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009937
9938 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009940
9941 - "drop-query"
9942 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9943 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9944 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9945 with a location-type redirect.
9946
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009947 - "append-slash"
9948 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9949 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9950 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9951 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9952
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009953 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9954 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9955 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9956 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9957 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9958 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9959 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9960
9961 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9962 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9963 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9964 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9965 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9966 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9967 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009968
9969 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9970 acl clear dst_port 80
9971 acl secure dst_port 8080
9972 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009973 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009974 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009975 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9976
9977 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009978 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9979 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9980 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009981 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009982
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009983 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9984 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9985 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9986
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009987 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009988 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009989
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009990 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009991 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9992 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9993 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009995 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009996
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009997
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009998retries <value>
9999 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10001 yes | no | yes | yes
10002 Arguments :
10003 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10004 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10005 default value is 3.
10006
10007 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10008 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10009 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10010
10011 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010012 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10013 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010014
10015 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10016 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10017
10018 See also : "option redispatch"
10019
10020
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010021retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010022 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10023 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10024 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10026 yes | no | yes | yes
10027 Arguments :
10028 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10029 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10030 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10031 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10032
10033 none never retry
10034
10035 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10036 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10037
10038 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10039 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10040 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10041 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10042 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10043 processing the request.
10044
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010045 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10046 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10047 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10048 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10049 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10050 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10051 overflow attack for example).
10052
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010053 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10054 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10055 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10056 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10057 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10058 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10059 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10060 amplify denial of service attacks.
10061
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010062 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10063 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10064 considered to be safe to retry.
10065
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010066 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10067 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10068 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10069 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10070 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010071
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010072 all-retryable-errors
10073 retry request for any error that are considered
10074 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10075 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10076 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10077
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010078 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10079 not cumulative.
10080
10081 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10082 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10083 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10084 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10085
10086 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10087 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10088 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10089 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10090 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10091 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10092 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10093 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10094 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10095 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10096 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10097 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10098
10099 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10100 should not use this directive.
10101
10102 The default is "conn-failure".
10103
10104 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10105
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010106server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010107 Declare a server in a backend
10108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10109 no | no | yes | yes
10110 Arguments :
10111 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010112 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010113 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010114
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010115 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10116 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10117 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10118 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010119 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10120 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10121 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10122 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10123 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010124 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10125 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10126 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10127 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10128 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10129 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10130 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010131 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010132 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10133 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10134 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10135 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10136 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10137 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010138 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10139 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010140 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10141 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010143 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010144 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10145 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10146 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10147 adding this value to the client's port.
10148
10149 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10150 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010151 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010152
10153 Examples :
10154 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10155 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010156 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010157 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10158 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10159 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010160
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010161 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10162 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10163 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10164 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10165 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10166
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010167 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10168 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010169
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010170server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010171 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010172 this backend.
10173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10174 no | no | yes | yes
10175
10176 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10177 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10178 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10179 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10180 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010181
10182 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10183 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10184
10185 global
10186 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10187
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010188 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010189 load-server-state-from-file
10190
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010191 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010192 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010193
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010194server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10195 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10196 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10198 no | no | yes | yes
10199
10200 Arguments:
10201 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10202
10203 <num | range>
10204 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10205 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10206 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10207 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10208
10209 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10210
10211 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10212
10213 <params*>
10214 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10215 keyword.
10216
10217 Examples:
10218 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10219 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10220 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10221
10222 # or
10223 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10224
10225 # would be equivalent to:
10226 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10227 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10228 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10229
10230
10231
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010232source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010233source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010234source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010235 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10237 yes | no | yes | yes
10238 Arguments :
10239 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10240 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010241
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010242 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010243 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10244 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10245 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10246 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10247 supported prefixes are :
10248 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10249 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10250 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010251 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010252 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10253 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010254
10255 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10256 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010257 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10258 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10259 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010260
10261 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10262 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10263 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10264 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10265 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10266 <addr>.
10267
10268 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10269 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10270 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10271 port.
10272
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010273 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10274 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10275 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10276 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010277 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010278 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10279 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10280 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10281 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10282 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10283 HTTP header.
10284
10285 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10286 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010287 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010288 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10289 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10290 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10291 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10292 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10293 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10294 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10295
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010296 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10297 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10298 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10299 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10300 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10301 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10302
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10304 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10305 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10306 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10307
10308 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10309 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10310 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10311 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10312 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10313 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10314
10315 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10316 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10317 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10318 there are two methods :
10319
10320 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10321 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10322 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10323 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10324 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10325 of the client ranges may be used.
10326
10327 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10328 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10329 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10330 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10331 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10332 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10333 same session.
10334
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010335 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10336 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10337 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010338 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010339
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010340 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010342 Examples :
10343 backend private
10344 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10345 source 192.168.1.200
10346
10347 backend transparent_ssl1
10348 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10349 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10350
10351 backend transparent_ssl2
10352 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10353 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10354 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10355
10356 backend transparent_ssl3
10357 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10358 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10359 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10360
10361 backend transparent_smtp
10362 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10363 # with Tproxy version 4.
10364 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10365
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010366 backend transparent_http
10367 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10368 # proxy.
10369 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010371 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010372 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10373
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010374
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010375srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10376 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10377 the connection on the server side.
10378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10379 yes | no | yes | yes
10380 Arguments :
10381 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10382
10383 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10384 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010385 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10386 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010387
10388 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10389
10390
10391srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10392 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10393 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10394 server side.
10395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10396 yes | no | yes | yes
10397 Arguments :
10398 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10399 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10400 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10401 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10402
10403 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10404 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010405 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10406 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010407
10408 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10409
10410
10411srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10412 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10414 yes | no | yes | yes
10415 Arguments :
10416 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10417 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10418 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10419 document.
10420
10421 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10422 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010423 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10424 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010425
10426 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10427
10428
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010429stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10430 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010432 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010433
10434 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10435 matched.
10436
10437 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10438 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10439
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010440 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10441 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010442 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010443
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010444 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10445 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10446 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10447 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010448
10449 Example :
10450 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10451 backend stats_localhost
10452 stats enable
10453 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10454
10455 Example :
10456 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10457 backend stats_auth
10458 stats enable
10459 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10460 stats admin if TRUE
10461
10462 Example :
10463 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10464 userlist stats-auth
10465 group admin users admin
10466 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10467 group readonly users haproxy
10468 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10469
10470 backend stats_auth
10471 stats enable
10472 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10473 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10474 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10475 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010477 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10478 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10479 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010480
10481
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010482stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10483 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010485 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486 Arguments :
10487 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10488
10489 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10490
10491 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10492 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10493 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10494 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10495 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10496 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10497
10498 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10499 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10500 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010501 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010502
10503 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10504 report using "stats scope".
10505
10506 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10507 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10508 unobvious parameters.
10509
10510 Example :
10511 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10512 backend public_www
10513 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10514 stats enable
10515 stats hide-version
10516 stats scope .
10517 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010518 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010519 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10520 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10521
10522 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10523 backend private_monitoring
10524 stats enable
10525 stats uri /admin?stats
10526 stats refresh 5s
10527
10528 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10529
10530
10531stats enable
10532 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010534 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010535 Arguments : none
10536
10537 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10538 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10539 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10540 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10541 - stats auth : no authentication
10542 - stats scope : no restriction
10543
10544 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10545 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10546 unobvious parameters.
10547
10548 Example :
10549 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10550 backend public_www
10551 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10552 stats enable
10553 stats hide-version
10554 stats scope .
10555 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010556 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10558 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10559
10560 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10561 backend private_monitoring
10562 stats enable
10563 stats uri /admin?stats
10564 stats refresh 5s
10565
10566 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10567
10568
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010569stats hide-version
10570 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010572 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010574
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010575 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10576 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10577 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10578 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10579 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10580 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10584 unobvious parameters.
10585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010586 Example :
10587 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10588 backend public_www
10589 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010590 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010591 stats hide-version
10592 stats scope .
10593 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010594 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010595 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10596 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010597
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010598 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10599 backend private_monitoring
10600 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010601 stats uri /admin?stats
10602 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010603
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010604 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010605
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010606
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010607stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10608 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10609 Access control for statistics
10610
10611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10612 no | no | yes | yes
10613
10614 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10615 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10616 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10617 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10618 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10619 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10620
10621 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10622 instance.
10623
10624 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10625 about ACL usage.
10626
10627
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010628stats realm <realm>
10629 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010632 Arguments :
10633 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10634 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10635 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10636
10637 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10638 using a backslash ('\').
10639
10640 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10641 only related to authentication.
10642
10643 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10644 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10645 unobvious parameters.
10646
10647 Example :
10648 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10649 backend public_www
10650 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10651 stats enable
10652 stats hide-version
10653 stats scope .
10654 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010655 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010656 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10657 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10658
10659 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10660 backend private_monitoring
10661 stats enable
10662 stats uri /admin?stats
10663 stats refresh 5s
10664
10665 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10666
10667
10668stats refresh <delay>
10669 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010671 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010672 Arguments :
10673 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10674 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10675 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10676 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10677 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10678 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10679
10680 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10681 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10682 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010683 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010684
10685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10687 unobvious parameters.
10688
10689 Example :
10690 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10691 backend public_www
10692 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10693 stats enable
10694 stats hide-version
10695 stats scope .
10696 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010698 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10699 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10700
10701 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10702 backend private_monitoring
10703 stats enable
10704 stats uri /admin?stats
10705 stats refresh 5s
10706
10707 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10708
10709
10710stats scope { <name> | "." }
10711 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010713 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010714 Arguments :
10715 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10716 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10717 section in which the statement appears.
10718
10719 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10720 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10721 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10722 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10723 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10724 exists.
10725
10726 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10727 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10728 unobvious parameters.
10729
10730 Example :
10731 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10732 backend public_www
10733 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10734 stats enable
10735 stats hide-version
10736 stats scope .
10737 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010738 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010739 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10740 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10741
10742 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10743 backend private_monitoring
10744 stats enable
10745 stats uri /admin?stats
10746 stats refresh 5s
10747
10748 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010750
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010751stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010752 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010754 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010755
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010756 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010757 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10758
10759 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10760 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10761
10762 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10763 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010764 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010765
10766 Example :
10767 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10768 backend private_monitoring
10769 stats enable
10770 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10771 stats uri /admin?stats
10772 stats refresh 5s
10773
10774 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10775 global section.
10776
10777
10778stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010779 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10781 yes | yes | yes | yes
10782 Arguments : none
10783
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010784 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010785 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10786 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10787 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10788 - IP (socket, server)
10789 - cookie (backend, server)
10790
10791 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10792 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010793 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010794
10795 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10796
10797
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010798stats show-modules
10799 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10801 yes | yes | yes | yes
10802 Arguments : none
10803
10804 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10805 values as a tooltip.
10806
10807 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10808 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10809 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10810
10811 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10812
10813
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010814stats show-node [ <name> ]
10815 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010818 Arguments:
10819 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10820 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10821
10822 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10823 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010824 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010825
10826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10828 unobvious parameters.
10829
10830 Example:
10831 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10832 backend private_monitoring
10833 stats enable
10834 stats show-node Europe-1
10835 stats uri /admin?stats
10836 stats refresh 5s
10837
10838 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10839 section.
10840
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010841
10842stats uri <prefix>
10843 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010845 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010846 Arguments :
10847 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10848 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10849 query string.
10850
10851 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10852 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10853 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10854 possible to reach it in the application.
10855
10856 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010857 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010858 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10859 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10860 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10861 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10862
10863 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10864 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10865 an address or a port to statistics only.
10866
10867 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10868 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10869 unobvious parameters.
10870
10871 Example :
10872 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10873 backend public_www
10874 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10875 stats enable
10876 stats hide-version
10877 stats scope .
10878 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010879 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010880 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10881 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10882
10883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10884 backend private_monitoring
10885 stats enable
10886 stats uri /admin?stats
10887 stats refresh 5s
10888
10889 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10890
10891
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010892stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10893 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010895 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010896
10897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010898 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010899 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010900 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010901 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10902
10903 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10904 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10905 the "stick-table" statement.
10906
10907 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10908 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10909 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10910 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10911 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10912
10913 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10914 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10915 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10916 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10917 transformation rules.
10918
10919 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10920 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10921 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10922 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10923 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10924 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10925 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10926
10927 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10928 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10929 ACL based conditions.
10930
10931 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10932 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10933 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10934 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10935
10936 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10937 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10938 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10939 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10940
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010941 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10942 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010944
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010945 Example :
10946 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10947 # last 30 minutes
10948 backend pop
10949 mode tcp
10950 balance roundrobin
10951 stick store-request src
10952 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10953 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10954 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10955
10956 backend smtp
10957 mode tcp
10958 balance roundrobin
10959 stick match src table pop
10960 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10961 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010963 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010964 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010965
10966
10967stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10968 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10970 no | no | yes | yes
10971
10972 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10973 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10974 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10975 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10976
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010977 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10978 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010979 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010980
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010981 Examples :
10982 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010983 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010984
10985 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10986 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10987 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10988
10989
10990 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10991 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10992 backend http
10993 mode http
10994 balance roundrobin
10995 stick on src table https
10996 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10997 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10998 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10999
11000 backend https
11001 mode tcp
11002 balance roundrobin
11003 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11004 stick on src
11005 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11006 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11007
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011008 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011009
11010
11011stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11012 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11014 no | no | yes | yes
11015
11016 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011017 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011018 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011020 server is selected.
11021
11022 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11023 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11024 the "stick-table" statement.
11025
11026 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11027 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11028 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11029 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11030 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11031 address.
11032
11033 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11034 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11035 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11036 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11037 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11038 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11039 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11040 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11041 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11042 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11043
11044 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11045 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11046 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11047 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11048 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11049 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11050 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11051
11052 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11053 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11054 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11055 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11056
11057 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11058 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11059 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11060 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11061 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11062 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011063 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11064 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11065 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11066 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11067 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11068 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011069
11070 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11071 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11072 the request.
11073
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011074 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11075 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011076 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011077
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011078 Example :
11079 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11080 # last 30 minutes
11081 backend pop
11082 mode tcp
11083 balance roundrobin
11084 stick store-request src
11085 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11086 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11087 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11088
11089 backend smtp
11090 mode tcp
11091 balance roundrobin
11092 stick match src table pop
11093 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11094 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11095
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011096 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011097 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011098
11099
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011100stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011102 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011103 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011105 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011106
11107 Arguments :
11108 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11109 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11110 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11111 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11112
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011113 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11114 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11115 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11116 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11117
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011118 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11119 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11120 instance.
11121
11122 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11123 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11124 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11125 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11126 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11127 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011128 to 32 characters.
11129
11130 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11131 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11132 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011133 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011134 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11135 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011136
11137 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011138 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11139 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011140 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11141 increase.
11142
11143 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011144 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11145 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11146 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147
11148 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11149 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11150 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11151 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011152 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011153 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11154 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11155 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11156 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11157 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11158 parameter (see below).
11159
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011160 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11161 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11162 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11163 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11164 soft restart.
11165
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011166 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11167 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011168
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011169 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11170 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11171 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11172 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011173 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011174 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011175 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11176 if not expiration delay is specified.
11177
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011178 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11179 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11180 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11181 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11182 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11183 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11184 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11185 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11186 token.
11187
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011188 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11189 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11190 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11191 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011192 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11193 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11194 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11195 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11196 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11197 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11198 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11199 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11200 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11201 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11202 types and their arguments.
11203
11204 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11205 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11206 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11207 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11208
11209 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11210 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11211 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011212 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011213
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011214 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11215 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11216 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011217 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011218 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011219 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011220
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011221 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11222 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11223 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11224 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11225
11226 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11227 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11228 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11229 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11230 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11231 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11232
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011233 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11234 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11235 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11236 they were received.
11237
11238 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11239 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11240 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11241 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11242 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11243
11244 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11245 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11246 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11247 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11248 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11249
11250 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11251 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11252 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11253
11254 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11255 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11256 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11257 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11258 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11259
11260 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11261 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11262 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11263 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11264 the client side.
11265
11266 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11267 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11268 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11269 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11270 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11271 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11272 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11273
11274 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11275 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11276 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11277 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11278 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11279 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011281
11282 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11283 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11284 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11285 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11286 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11287 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11288
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011289 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11290 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11291 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11292 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11293 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11294
11295 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11296 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11297 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11298 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11299 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11300 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11301
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011302 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011303 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011304 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11305 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11306
11307 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11308 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11309 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11310 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11311 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11312 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11313 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11314 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11315 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11316 recommended for better fairness.
11317
11318 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011319 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011320 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11321 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11322
11323 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11324 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11325 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11326 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11327 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11328 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11329 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11330 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11331 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11332 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011333
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011334 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11335 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11337 reference it.
11338
11339 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11340 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011341 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11342 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11343 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011345 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11346 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11347 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11348 something that can be ignored.
11349
11350 Example:
11351 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11352 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11353 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11354 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11355
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011356 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011357 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358
11359
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011360stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011361 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11363 no | no | yes | yes
11364
11365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011366 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011367 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011368 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011369 server is selected.
11370
11371 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11372 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11373 the "stick-table" statement.
11374
11375 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11376 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11377 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11378 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11379
11380 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11381 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11382 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11383 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11384 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11385 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011386 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011387 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11388 rules.
11389
11390 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11391 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11392 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11393 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11394 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11395 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11396 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11397
11398 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11399 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11400 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11401 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11402
11403 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11404 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11405 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11406 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11407 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11408 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011409 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11410 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11411 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11412 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11413 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11414 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11415 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11416 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11417 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011418
11419 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11420
11421 Example :
11422 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11423 backend https
11424 mode tcp
11425 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011426 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011427 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011428
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011429 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11430 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11431
11432 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11433 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11434 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11435
11436 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11437 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011438
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011439 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11440 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11441 # at offset 44.
11442
11443 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11444 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11445
11446 # Learn on response if server hello.
11447 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011448
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011449 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11450 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11451
11452 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11453 extraction.
11454
11455
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011456tcp-check comment <string>
11457 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11458 it fails.
11459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11460 yes | no | yes | yes
11461
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011462 Arguments :
11463 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11464 rule fails.
11465
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011466 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11467 user-friendly error reporting.
11468
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011469 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11470 "tcp-check expect".
11471
11472
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011473tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11474 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011475 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011476 Opens a new connection
11477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011479
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011480 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011481 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11482
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011483 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011484 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011485
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011486 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011487 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11488 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011489 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011490
11491 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011492
11493 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11494
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011495 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11496
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011497 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11498
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011499 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11500
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011501 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11502 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11503 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11504 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11505
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011506 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11507 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11508 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11509 haproxy -vv.
11510
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011511 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011512
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011513 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11514 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11515 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11516
11517 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11518 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11519 of the sequence.
11520
11521 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11522 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11523 do.
11524
11525 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11526 unset-var or comment rules.
11527
11528 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011529 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11530 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11531 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11532 option tcp-check
11533 tcp-check connect
11534 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11535 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11536 tcp-check send \r\n
11537 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11538 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11539 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11540 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11541 tcp-check send \r\n
11542 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11543 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11544
11545 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11546 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011547 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011548 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11549 tcp-check connect port 143
11550 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11551 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11552
11553 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11554
11555
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011556tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011557 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011558 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011559 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011562 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011563
11564 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011565 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11566
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011567 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11568 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11569 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11570 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11571 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11572 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11573 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11574 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11575 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11576 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11577
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011578 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011579 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11580 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011581 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11582 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11583 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11584
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011585 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11586 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11587 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011588 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11589 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011590 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11591 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011592 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11593 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011594 By default "L7OK" is used.
11595
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011596 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11597 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011598 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11599 supported :
11600 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11601 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011602 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11603 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11604 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11605 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11606 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011607
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011608 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011609 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011610 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11611 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11612 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11613 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011614 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11615
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011616 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11617 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11618 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11619 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11620
11621 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11622 informational message reported in logs if an error
11623 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11624 log-format string.
11625
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011626 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11627 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11628 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11629 followed by some converters.
11630
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011631 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11632 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11633 with the usual backslash ('\').
11634 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011635 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011636 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11637 used upper or lower case.
11638
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011639 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11640
11641 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11643 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11644 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11645 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11646 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11647 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11648 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11649
11650 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11651 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11652 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11653 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11654 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11655 expression.
11656
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011657 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11658 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11659 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11660 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11661 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11662 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11663
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011664 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11665 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11666 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11667 this exact hexadecimal string.
11668 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11669
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011670 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11671 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11672 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11673 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11674 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11675 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11676 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11677 size.
11678
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011679 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11680 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11681 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11682 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11683 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11684 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11685 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11686 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11687 in a binary string before matching the response's
11688 buffer.
11689
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011690 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011691 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011692 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11693 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11694 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11695 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11696 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11697 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11698 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11699 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11700 the null character.
11701
11702 Examples :
11703 # perform a POP check
11704 option tcp-check
11705 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11706
11707 # perform an IMAP check
11708 option tcp-check
11709 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11710
11711 # look for the redis master server
11712 option tcp-check
11713 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011714 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011715 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11716 tcp-check expect string role:master
11717 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11718 tcp-check expect string +OK
11719
11720
11721 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011722 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011723
11724
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011725tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11726tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11727 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11728 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011730 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011731
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011732 Arguments :
11733 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11734
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011735 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11736 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011737
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011738 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11739 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011740
11741 Examples :
11742 # look for the redis master server
11743 option tcp-check
11744 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11745 tcp-check expect string role:master
11746
11747 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011748 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011749
11750
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011751tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11752tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11753 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11754 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011756 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011757
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011758 Arguments :
11759 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011760
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011761 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11762 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011763
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011764 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11765 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11766 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011767
11768 Examples :
11769 # redis check in binary
11770 option tcp-check
11771 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11772 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11773
11774
11775 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011776 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777
11778
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011779tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011780 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011782 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011783
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011784 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011785 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11786 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11787 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11788 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11789 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11791 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11792 and '-'.
11793
11794 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011796 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011797 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11798
11799
11800tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011801 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011803 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011804
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011805 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011806 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11807 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11810 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11811 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11812 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11813 and '-'.
11814
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011815 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011816 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11817
11818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011819tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11820 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11822 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011824 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11825 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011826
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011827 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011828
11829 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11830 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011831 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11832 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11833 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11834 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11835 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11836 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011837
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011838 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11839 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11840 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11841 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011842
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011843 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011844 - accept :
11845 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11846 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11847 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 - reject :
11850 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11851 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11852 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11853 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11854 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11855 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11856 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11857 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11858 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11859 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11860 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011861 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011862
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011863 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11864 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11865 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11866 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11867 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11868 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11869 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11870 hosts.
11871
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011872 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11873 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11874 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11875 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11876 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11877 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11878 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11879 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11880
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011881 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11882 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11883 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11884 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11885 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11886 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11887 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11888 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11889 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011890 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11891 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011892
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011893 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011894 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011895 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11896 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11897 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011898 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011899 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011900 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11901 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11902 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11903 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11904 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11905 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11906 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011908 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011909 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011911 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011912 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11913 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11914 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11917 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11918 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11919 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011921 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11922 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11923 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11924 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11925 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011926 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11927 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11928 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11929 layer7 information is extracted.
11930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011931 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11932 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11933 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11934 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11935 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011936
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011937 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11938 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11939 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11940 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11941
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011942 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11943 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11944 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11945 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11946
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011947 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11948 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11949 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11950 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11951 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011952
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011953 - set-src <expr> :
11954 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11955 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11956 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011957 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011959 Arguments:
11960 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11961 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011962
11963 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011964 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11965
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011966 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11967 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011968
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011969 - set-src-port <expr> :
11970 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11971 expression.
11972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011973 Arguments:
11974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11975 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011976
11977 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011978 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11979
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011980 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11981 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11982 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011983
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011984 - set-dst <expr> :
11985 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11986 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11987 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11988 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11989 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11990
11991 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11992 followed by some converters.
11993
11994 Example:
11995
11996 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11997 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11998
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011999 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12000 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12001
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012002 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12003 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12004 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12005 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12006
12007
12008 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12009 followed by some converters.
12010
12011 Example:
12012
12013 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12014
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012015 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12016 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12017 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12018
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012019 - "silent-drop" :
12020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012021 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012022 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12023 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12024 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12025 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12026 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012027 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12028 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012029 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12030 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012031 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012032 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12033 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12034 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12035 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012037 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12038 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12039 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012041 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12042 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12043 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012045 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012046 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012047 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012049 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12050 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12051 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012053 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012054 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12055 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012056
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012057 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12058
12059 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12060
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012061 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12062
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012063 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012064
12065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012066tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12067 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012069 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012070 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012071 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12072 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012074 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012076 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012077 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12078 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012079 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12080 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012081
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012082 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12083 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12084 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12085 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012086 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12087 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12088 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12089 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12090 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12091 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012092 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012093 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012095 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12096 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12097 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12098 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012099
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012100 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012101 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012102 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012103 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12104 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012105 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012106 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012107 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012108 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012109 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012110 - set-dst <expr>
12111 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012112 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012113 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012114 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012115 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012116 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012117 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012119 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12120 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012121 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12122 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012123
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012124 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12125 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12126 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12127 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12128 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12129 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012131 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12133 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012134
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012135 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12136 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12137 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12138 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12139 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12140 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012142 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012143 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12144 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12145 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12146 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12147 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12148 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12149 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12150 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12151 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12152 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012153
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012154 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012155 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12156 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12157 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012158
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012159 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12160 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12161
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012162 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012163 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12164 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012165
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012166 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12167 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012168 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012169 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12170 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012171 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012173 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12175 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012176 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012177 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12178 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012179
12180 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12181 followed by some converters.
12182
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012183 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12184 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12185 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12186 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12187 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12188 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12189 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012190 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012191 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12192 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12193
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012194 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12195
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012196 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12197 <var-name>.
12198
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012199 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12200 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12201 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12202 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12203 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12204
12205 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12206 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12207 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12208 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12209 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12210 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12211 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12212 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12213 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12214 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12215 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12216
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012217 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12218 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12219 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12220 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12221 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12222
12223 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12224
12225 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12226
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012227 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12228 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12229 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12230 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12231 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12232 evaluated.
12233
12234 Example:
12235 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12236
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012237 Example:
12238
12239 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012240 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012241
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012242 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012243 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012244 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012245 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12246 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012247 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012248 tcp-request content reject
12249
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012250 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12251 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12252 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12253 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12254 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12255 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12256 ...
12257 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012259 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012260 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12261 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12262 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012263 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012264
12265 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12266 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12267 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012268 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012269 tcp-request content reject
12270
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012271 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012272 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012273 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012274 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012275 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12276 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012277
12278 Example:
12279 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12280 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012281 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012284 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012285
12286 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012287 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012288 # protecting all our sites
12289 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012290 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12291 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012292 ...
12293 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12294
12295 backend http_dynamic
12296 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012297 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012298 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012299 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012300 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012301 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012302 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012305
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012306 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12307 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012308
12309
12310tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12311 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012313 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314 Arguments :
12315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12317 as explained at the top of this document.
12318
12319 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12320 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12321 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12322 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12323 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12324
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012325 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12326 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12327 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12328 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12329
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012330 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12331 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012332 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012333 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012334 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12335 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12336 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12337 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012338
12339 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12340 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12341 it pass through unaffected.
12342
12343 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12344 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12345 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012346 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012347 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12348 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012349 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12350 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12351 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012352
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012353 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012354 "timeout client".
12355
12356
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012357tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12358 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12360 no | no | yes | yes
12361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012362 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12363 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012364
12365 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012367 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012368 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12369 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012370 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12371 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012372
12373 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12374
12375 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12376 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12377 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12378 inserted.
12379
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012380 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012381 - accept :
12382 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12383 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12384 the rules evaluation.
12385
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012386 - close :
12387 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12388 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12389 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12390 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12391 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12392 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012393 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012394 protocols.
12395
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012396 - reject :
12397 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12398 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012399 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012400
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012401 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12402 Sets a variable.
12403
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012404 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12405 Unsets a variable.
12406
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012407 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12408 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12409 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12410 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12411
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012412 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12413 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12414 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12415 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12416
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012417 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12418 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12419 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12420 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12421 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012422
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012423 - "silent-drop" :
12424 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012425 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012426 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12427 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12428 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12429 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12430 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12432 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012433 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12434 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012435 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012436 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12437 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12438 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12439 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12440
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012441 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12442 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12443
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012444 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12445 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12446 for changing the default action to a reject.
12447
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012448 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12449 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12450 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12451 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012452 period.
12453
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012454 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12455 declared inline.
12456
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012457 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12458 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012459 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012460 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12461 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012462 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012463 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012464 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012465 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12466 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012467 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012468 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12469 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012470
12471 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12472 followed by some converters.
12473
12474 Example:
12475
12476 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12477
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012478 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12479 <var-name>.
12480
12481 Example:
12482
12483 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12484
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012485 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12486 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12487 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12488 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12489 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12490
12491 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12492
12493 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12494
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012495 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12496
12497 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12498
12499
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012500tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12501 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12503 no | yes | yes | no
12504 Arguments :
12505 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12506 below.
12507
12508 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012510 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012511 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12512 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12513 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12514 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12515 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12516 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12517 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012518 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012519 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12520 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12521 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12522 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12523 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12524 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12525 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12526 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12527 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12528 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12529 instead.
12530
12531 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12532 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12533 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12534 rules which may be inserted.
12535
12536 Several types of actions are supported :
12537 - accept : the request is accepted
12538 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12539 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12540 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012541 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012542 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012543 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012544 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012545 - silent-drop
12546
12547 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12548 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12549 sections for a complete description.
12550
12551 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12552 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12553 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12554
12555 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12556 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12557 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12558 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12559 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12560
12561 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12562 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12563
12564 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12565 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12566 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12567
12568 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12569 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12570 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12571
12572 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12573 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12574 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12575
12576 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12577 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12578 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12579
12580 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12581
12582 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12583
12584
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012585tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12586 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12588 no | no | yes | yes
12589 Arguments :
12590 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12591 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12592 as explained at the top of this document.
12593
12594 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12595
12596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012597timeout check <timeout>
12598 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12599 established.
12600
12601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12602 yes | no | yes | yes
12603 Arguments:
12604 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12605 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12606 as explained at the top of this document.
12607
12608 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12609 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012610 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012611 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012612 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12613 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12614 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012615
12616 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12617 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12618
12619 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12620 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012621 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012622
12623 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12624 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12625 forget about it.
12626
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012627 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12628 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012629
12630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012631timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012632 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12634 yes | yes | yes | no
12635 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012636 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12638 as explained at the top of this document.
12639
12640 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12641 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12642 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012643 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12644 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12645 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12646 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012647 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12648 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12649 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012650 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012651 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12653 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012654 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12655 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012656
12657 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12658 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12659 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12660 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012661 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012662 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12663
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012664 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012665
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012666 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012668
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012669timeout client-fin <timeout>
12670 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12672 yes | yes | yes | no
12673 Arguments :
12674 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12675 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12676 as explained at the top of this document.
12677
12678 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12679 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12680 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12681 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12682 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12683 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12684 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012685 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12686 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12687 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012688
12689 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12690 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12691 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12692
12693 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12694
12695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012696timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012697 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12699 yes | no | yes | yes
12700 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012701 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012702 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12703 as explained at the top of this document.
12704
12705 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012706 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012707 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012708 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012709 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12710 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012711
12712 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12713 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12714 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12715 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012716 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012717 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12718
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012719 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012721
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012722timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12723 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12725 yes | yes | yes | yes
12726 Arguments :
12727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12729 as explained at the top of this document.
12730
12731 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12732 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12733 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12734 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12735 once the request has started to present itself.
12736
12737 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12738 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12739 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12740 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12741 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12742
12743 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12744 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12745 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12746 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12747
12748 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12749 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012750 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012751 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12752 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012753 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012754
12755 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12756 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12757 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12758 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12759
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012760 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12761 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012762 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12763
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012764 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12765
12766
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012767timeout http-request <timeout>
12768 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012770 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012771 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012772 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12774 as explained at the top of this document.
12775
12776 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12777 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12778 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12779 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12780 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12781 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12782 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012783 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12784 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12785 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12786 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012787 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012788 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12789 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012790
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012791 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12792 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12793 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12794 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12795 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012796 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012797
12798 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12799 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012800 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012801 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12802 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12803
12804 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012805 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12806 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12807 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012808
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012809 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012810 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012811
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012812
12813timeout queue <timeout>
12814 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12816 yes | no | yes | yes
12817 Arguments :
12818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12820 as explained at the top of this document.
12821
12822 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12823 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12824 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12825 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12826 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12827
12828 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12829 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12830 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12831 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12832
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012833 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012834
12835
12836timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012837 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12839 yes | no | yes | yes
12840 Arguments :
12841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12843 as explained at the top of this document.
12844
12845 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12846 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12847 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12848 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12849 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12850 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12851 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12852
12853 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12854 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12855 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12856 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12857 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012858 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012859 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012860 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12861 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012862 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12863 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012864
12865 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12866 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12867 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12868 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012869 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012870 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12871
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012872 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012873
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012874
12875timeout server-fin <timeout>
12876 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12878 yes | no | yes | yes
12879 Arguments :
12880 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12881 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12882 as explained at the top of this document.
12883
12884 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12885 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12886 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12887 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12888 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12889 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12890 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12891 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12892 situations, it should not be needed.
12893
12894 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12895 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12896 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12897
12898 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12899
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012900
12901timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012902 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12904 yes | yes | yes | yes
12905 Arguments :
12906 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12907 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12908 as explained at the top of this document.
12909
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012910 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12911 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12912 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012913
12914 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12915 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12916 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12917 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012918 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012919
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012920 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012921
12922
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012923timeout tunnel <timeout>
12924 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12926 yes | no | yes | yes
12927 Arguments :
12928 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12930 as explained at the top of this document.
12931
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012932 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012933 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12934 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12935 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012936 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12937 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012938 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12939 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12940 specified.
12941
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012942 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12943 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12944 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12945 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12946 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12947 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12948 state.
12949
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012950 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12951 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12952 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12953 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012954 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012955
12956 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12957 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12958 forget about it.
12959
12960 Example :
12961 defaults http
12962 option http-server-close
12963 timeout connect 5s
12964 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012965 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012966 timeout server 30s
12967 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12968
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012969 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012970
12971
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012972transparent (deprecated)
12973 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012975 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012976 Arguments : none
12977
12978 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12979 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12980 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12981 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12982 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12983 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12984 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12985 appropriate server.
12986
12987 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12988
12989 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12990 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12991
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012992 See also: "option transparent"
12993
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012994unique-id-format <string>
12995 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12997 yes | yes | yes | no
12998 Arguments :
12999 <string> is a log-format string.
13000
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013001 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13002 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13003 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13004 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013005
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013006 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13007 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13008 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13009 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13010 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13011 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13012 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13013 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013014
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013015 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13016 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013017
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013018 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013019
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013020 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013021
13022 will generate:
13023
13024 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13025
13026 See also: "unique-id-header"
13027
13028unique-id-header <name>
13029 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13031 yes | yes | yes | no
13032 Arguments :
13033 <name> is the name of the header.
13034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013035 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13036 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013037
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013038 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013039
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013040 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013041 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13042
13043 will generate:
13044
13045 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13046
13047 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013048
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013049use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013050 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13052 no | yes | yes | no
13053 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013054 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13055 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013056
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013057 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13058 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013059
13060 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13061 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13062 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013063 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013064 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013065 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13066 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067
13068 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13069 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13070 assign the backend.
13071
13072 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13073 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13074 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13075 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13076 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13077 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13078
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013079 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013080 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013081 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13082 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13083 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13084
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013085 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13086 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13087 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13088 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13089 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13090 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13091 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13092 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13093 cannot be forced from the request.
13094
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013095 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013096 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13097 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13098
13099 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13100 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013101
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013102use-fcgi-app <name>
13103 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13105 no | no | yes | yes
13106 Arguments :
13107 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13108
13109 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013110
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013111use-server <server> if <condition>
13112use-server <server> unless <condition>
13113 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13115 no | no | yes | yes
13116 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013117 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13118 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013119
13120 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13121
13122 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13123 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13124 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13125
13126 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13127 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13128 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13129 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13130 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13131 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13132 matches will assign the server.
13133
13134 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13135 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13136 with the next rules until one matches.
13137
13138 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13139 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13140 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13141 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13142
13143 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13144 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13145 stripped.
13146
13147 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13148 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013149 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13150 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13151 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013152
13153 Example :
13154 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13155 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13156 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13157 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013158 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013159 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013160 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013161 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13162 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13163
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013164 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13165 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13166 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13167 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013168 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013169 and we fall back to load balancing.
13170
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013171 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013172
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013173
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100131745. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013175--------------------------
13176
13177The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13178depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13179settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13180written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13181described in this section.
13182
13183
131845.1. Bind options
13185-----------------
13186
13187The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13188as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13189no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13190parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13191while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13192provided immediately after the setting name.
13193
13194The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13195
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013196accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13197 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13198 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13199 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13200 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13201 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13202 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13203 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13204 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13205 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013206 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13207 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13208 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013209
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013210accept-proxy
13211 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013212 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13213 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013214 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13215 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13216 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13217 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013218 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013219 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13220 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013221 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13222 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013223
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013224allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013225 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013226 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013227 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013228 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13229 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013230
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013231alpn <protocols>
13232 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13233 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13234 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013235 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013236 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013237 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13238 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13239 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13240 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13241 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13242 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13243 preference, like below :
13244
13245 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013246
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013247backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013248 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013249 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13250
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013251curves <curves>
13252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13253 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13254 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13255 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13256 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13257 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13258
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013259ecdhe <named curve>
13260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013261 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13262 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013263
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013264ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13266 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13267 client's certificate.
13268
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013269ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13271 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13272 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13273 error is ignored.
13274
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013275ca-sign-file <cafile>
13276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13277 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13278 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13279 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13280 'generate-certificates' for details.
13281
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013282ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13284 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13285 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13286 'generate-certificates' for details.
13287
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013288ca-verify-file <cafile>
13289 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13290 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13291 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13292 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13293 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013295ciphers <ciphers>
13296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13297 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013298 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013299 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013300 information and recommendations see e.g.
13301 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13302 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13303 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13304
13305ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13308 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13309 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013310 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13311 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013312
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013313crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13315 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13316 to verify client's certificate.
13317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013318crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13320 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13321 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13322 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13323 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013324 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13325 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013326
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013327 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13328 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13329
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013330 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13331 are loaded.
13332
13333 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013334 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13335 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13336 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13337 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13338 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13339 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13340 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013341 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013342
13343 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13344 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13345 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13346 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013347 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13348 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013349
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013350 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013352 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013353 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013354 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13355 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013356 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13357 clients).
13358
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013359 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13360 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13361 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13362 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13363 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13364 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13365 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13366 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13367 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13368 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13369 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13370 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13371 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13372
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013373 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13374 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13375 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13376 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13377 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13378
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013379 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13380 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13381 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13382 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013383
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013384 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13385 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13386 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013387
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013388crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013389 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013390 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013391 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013392 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013393
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013394crt-list <file>
13395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013396 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13397 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013398
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013399 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13400
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013401 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13402 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13403 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13404 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13405 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013406
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013407 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013408 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13409 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13410 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13411 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13412 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013413 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13414 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13415 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013416
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013417 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13418 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13419 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013420
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013421 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13422
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013423 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13424 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13425 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13426 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13427 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13428 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13429 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13430 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013431
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013432 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013433 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013434 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013435 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013436 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013437 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013439defer-accept
13440 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13441 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13442 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013443 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013444 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13445 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13446 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13447 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13448 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13449 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13450 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13451
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013452expose-fd listeners
13453 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13454 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013455 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13456 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013458
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013459force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013460 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013461 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013462 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013463 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013464
13465force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013466 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013467 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013468 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013469
13470force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013471 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013472 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013473 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013474
13475force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013476 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013477 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013478 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013479
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013480force-tlsv13
13481 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13482 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013483 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013484
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013485generate-certificates
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13487 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13488 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13489 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13490 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13491 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13492 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13493 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13494 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13495 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13496 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13497
13498 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13499 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013500 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013501 certificate is used many times.
13502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013503gid <gid>
13504 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13505 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13506 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13507 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13508 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13509
13510group <group>
13511 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13512 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13513 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13514 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13515 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13516
13517id <id>
13518 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13519 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13520 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13521 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13522
13523interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013524 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13525 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13526 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13527 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13528 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13529 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013530 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13531 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13532 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13533 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13534 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13535 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013536
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013537level <level>
13538 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13539 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13540 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013541 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013542 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13543 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13544 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013546 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013547 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013548 all counters).
13549
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013550severity-output <format>
13551 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13552 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13553 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13554 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13555 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13556 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13557 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13558 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13559 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13560 rfc5424 convention.
13561
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013562maxconn <maxconn>
13563 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13564 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13565 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13566 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13567 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13568 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13569 eat all memory.
13570
13571mode <mode>
13572 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13573 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13574 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13575 UNIX sockets.
13576
13577mss <maxseg>
13578 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13579 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13580 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13581 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13582 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13583 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13584 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13585 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13586 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13587 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13588 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13589
13590name <name>
13591 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13592 page.
13593
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013594namespace <name>
13595 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13596 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13597 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13598 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13599
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013600nice <nice>
13601 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13602 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13603 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13604 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13605 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13606 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13607 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13608 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13609 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13610 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13611 one for an RDP socket.
13612
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013613no-ca-names
13614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13615 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013616 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013617
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013618no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013620 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013621 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013622 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013623 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13624 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013625
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013626no-tls-tickets
13627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13628 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13629 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013630 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13631 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013632 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13633 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13634 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013635
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013636no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013637 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013638 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013639 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013640 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013641 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13642 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013643
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013644no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013646 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013647 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013648 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013649 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13650 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013651
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013652no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013654 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013655 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013656 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013657 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13658 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013659
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013660no-tlsv13
13661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13662 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13663 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13664 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013665 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13666 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013667
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013668npn <protocols>
13669 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13670 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13671 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013672 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013673 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013674 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13675 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13676 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13677 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13678 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013679
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013680prefer-client-ciphers
13681 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13682 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13683 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013684 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13685 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13686 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013687
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013688process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013689 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013690 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013691 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013692 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13693 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13694 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13695 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013696 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013697 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13698 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13699 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13700 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13701 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013702
13703 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13704
13705 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13706 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13707 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13708 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13709 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13710 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13711 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13712 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013713
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013714proto <name>
13715 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13716 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13717 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013718 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13719 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13720
13721 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13722 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13723 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13724 also reported (flag=HTX).
13725
13726 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13727 a bind line :
13728
13729 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13730 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13731 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13732
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013733 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013734 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013735 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013736 h2" on the bind line.
13737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013738ssl
13739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013740 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013741 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13742 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013743 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13744 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013746ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13747 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013748 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13749 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13750 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013751 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13752
13753ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013754 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13755 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13756 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13757 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013758
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013759strict-sni
13760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13761 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13762 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13763 See the "crt" option for more information.
13764
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013765tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013766 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013767 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13768 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013769 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013770 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13771 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13772 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13773 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13774 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13775 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13776 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13777
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013778tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013779 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013780 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13781 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13782 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13783 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13784 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13785 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13786 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013787 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13788 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13789 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013790
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013791tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13792 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013793 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13794 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13795 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13796 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13797 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13798 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13799 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13800 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13801 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13802 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013803 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13804 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13805
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013806transparent
13807 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13808 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13809 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13810 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13811 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13812 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13813 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13814 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13815 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13816 so check for support with your vendor.
13817
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013818v4v6
13819 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13820 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13821 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13822 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013823 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013824
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013825v6only
13826 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13827 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13828 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013829 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13830 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013832uid <uid>
13833 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13834 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13835 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13836 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13837 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13838
13839user <user>
13840 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13841 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13842 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13843 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13844 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13845
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013846verify [none|optional|required]
13847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13848 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13849 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13850 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13851 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013852 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13853 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13854 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13855 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200138575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013858------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013860The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13861which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13862arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13863settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13864after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13865Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13866address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013868 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013869 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013870
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013871Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13872keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13873
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013874The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013875
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013876addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013877 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013878 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13879 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13880 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13881 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13882 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013883
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013884agent-check
13885 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013886 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013887 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13888 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13889 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013890
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013891 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013892 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013893 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13894 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13895 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013897 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13898 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13899 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13900 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13901 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013902
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013903 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013904 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013905
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013906 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13907 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13908 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013909
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013910 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13911 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13912 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013913
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013914 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013915 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13916 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13917 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13918 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013920 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013921
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013922 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13923 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013924
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013925 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13926 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13927 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13928 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13929 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13930 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13931 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13932 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13933 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013934
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013935 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13936 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013937 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13938 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13939 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013940 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013941
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013942 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013943 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013944
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013945agent-send <string>
13946 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13947 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13948 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13949 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13950 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13951
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013952agent-inter <delay>
13953 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13954 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13955
13956 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13957 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13958 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13959 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13960 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13961 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13962 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13963 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13964 of backends use the same servers.
13965
13966 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13967
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013968agent-addr <addr>
13969 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13970
13971 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13972 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13973 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13974 hostname, it will be resolved.
13975
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013976agent-port <port>
13977 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13978
13979 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13980
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013981allow-0rtt
13982 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013983 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13984 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013985
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013986alpn <protocols>
13987 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13988 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13989 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013990 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013991 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13992 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13993 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13994 now obsolete NPN extension.
13995 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13996 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13997
13998 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014000backup
14001 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14002 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14003 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14004 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014005 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14006 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014007
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014008ca-file <cafile>
14009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14010 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14011 server's certificate.
14012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014013check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014014 This option enables health checks on a server:
14015 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14016 considered available.
14017 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14018 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14019 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14020 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14021 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14022 set.
14023 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14024 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14025 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14026 exchanges succeed.
14027
14028 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14029 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14030 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14031 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14032 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014033 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014034 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14035
14036 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14037 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14038
14039 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14040 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14041
14042 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14043 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14044 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14045 available.
14046
14047 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14048 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14049 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14050
14051 Example:
14052 # simple tcp check
14053 backend foo
14054 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14055 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14056 backend foo
14057 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14058 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14059 backend foo
14060 option tcp-check
14061 tcp-check connect
14062 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014063
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014064check-send-proxy
14065 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14066 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14067 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14068 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14069 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14070 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14071 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14072
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014073check-alpn <protocols>
14074 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14075 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14076 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14077
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014078check-proto <name>
14079 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14080 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14081 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014082 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14083 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14084
14085 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14086 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14087 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14088 also reported (flag=HTX).
14089
14090 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14091 directive on a server line:
14092
14093 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14094 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14095 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14096 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14097
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014098 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014099 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14100 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14101
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014102check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014103 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014104 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14105 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014106
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014107check-ssl
14108 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14109 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14110 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14111 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014112 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014113 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14114 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014115 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014116 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14117 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014118
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014119check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014120 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014121 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14122 for normal traffic.
14123
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014124ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14126 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14127 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014128 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14129 information and recommendations see e.g.
14130 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14131 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14132 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014133
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014134ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14136 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14137 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14138 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014139 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14140 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14141 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014143cookie <value>
14144 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14145 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14146 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14147 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14148 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14149 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14150 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14151
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014152crl-file <crlfile>
14153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14154 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14155 to verify server's certificate.
14156
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014157crt <cert>
14158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14159 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14160 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14161 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14162 certificate request.
14163
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014164disabled
14165 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14166 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14167 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14168 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14169 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014170 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014171
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014172enabled
14173 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14174 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14175 default value.
14176 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14177 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014179error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014180 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14181 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14182 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014184 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014186fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014187 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14188 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14189 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14190
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014191force-sslv3
14192 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14193 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014194 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014195 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014196
14197force-tlsv10
14198 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014199 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014200 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014201
14202force-tlsv11
14203 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014204 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014205 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014206
14207force-tlsv12
14208 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014209 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014210 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014211
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014212force-tlsv13
14213 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14214 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014215 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014217id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014218 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14219 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14220 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014221
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014222init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14223 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14224 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014225 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014226 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14227 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14228 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14229 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14230 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14231 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14232 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14233 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14234 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014235 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014236 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14237 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14238 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14239 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14240 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14241 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014243
14244 Example:
14245 defaults
14246 # never fail on address resolution
14247 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014249inter <delay>
14250fastinter <delay>
14251downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014252 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14253 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14254 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14255 between checks depending on the server state :
14256
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014257 Server state | Interval used
14258 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14259 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14260 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14261 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14262 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14263 or yet unchecked. |
14264 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14265 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14266 | "inter" otherwise.
14267 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014269 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14270 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14271 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14272 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014273 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14274 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14275 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14276 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14277 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014278
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014279log-proto <logproto>
14280 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14281 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14282 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14283 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014285maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014286 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14287 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014288 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14289 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014290 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14291 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14292 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14293 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14294
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014295 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14296 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14297 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14298 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14299 than 50 concurrent requests.
14300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014301maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014302 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14303 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14304 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14305 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014306 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14307 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14308 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14309 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14310 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14311 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14312 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014313
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014314max-reuse <count>
14315 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14316 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14317 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14318 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14319 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14320 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14321 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14322 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014324minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014325 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14326 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14327 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14328 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14329 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14330 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014331 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014333
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014334namespace <name>
14335 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14336 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14337 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14338 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14339
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014340no-agent-check
14341 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14342 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14343 default value.
14344 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14345 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14346
14347no-backup
14348 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14349 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14350 default value.
14351 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14352 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14353
14354no-check
14355 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14356 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14357 default value.
14358 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14359 "default-server" "check" setting.
14360
14361no-check-ssl
14362 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14363 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14364 default value.
14365 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14366 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14367
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014368no-send-proxy
14369 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14370 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14371 default value.
14372 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14373 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14374
14375no-send-proxy-v2
14376 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14377 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14378 default value.
14379 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14380 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14381
14382no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14385 default value.
14386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14387 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14388
14389no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14392 default value.
14393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14394 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14395
14396no-ssl
14397 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14398 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14399 default value.
14400 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14401 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14402
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014403 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14404 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14405 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14406
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014407no-ssl-reuse
14408 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14409 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14410 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14411 and for paranoid users.
14412
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014413no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014414 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14415 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014416 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014417
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014418 Supported in default-server: No
14419
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014420no-tls-tickets
14421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14422 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14423 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014424 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14425 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014426 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14427 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14428 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014429 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014430
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014431no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014432 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014433 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14434 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014435 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14436 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014437 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014438
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014439 Supported in default-server: No
14440
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014441no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014442 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014443 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14444 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014445 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14446 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014447 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014448
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014449 Supported in default-server: No
14450
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014451no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014452 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014453 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14454 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014455 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14456 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014457 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014458
14459 Supported in default-server: No
14460
14461no-tlsv13
14462 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14463 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14464 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14465 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14466 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014467 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014468
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014469 Supported in default-server: No
14470
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014471no-verifyhost
14472 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14473 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14474 default value.
14475 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14476 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014477
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014478no-tfo
14479 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14480 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14481 default value.
14482 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14483 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14484
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014485non-stick
14486 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14487 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14488 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14489
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014490npn <protocols>
14491 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14492 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14493 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014494 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014495 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14496 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14497 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014499observe <mode>
14500 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14501 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14502 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14503 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14504 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14505 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014506 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014507
14508 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014510on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014511 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14512 Currently, four modes are available:
14513 - fastinter: force fastinter
14514 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14515 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14516 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14517 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14518
14519 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14520
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014521on-marked-down <action>
14522 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14523 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014524 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14525 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14526 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14527 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14528 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14529 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14530 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14531 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014532
14533 Actions are disabled by default
14534
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014535on-marked-up <action>
14536 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14537 Currently one action is available:
14538 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14539 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14540 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14541 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014542 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14543 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014544 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14545 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14546
14547 Actions are disabled by default
14548
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014549pool-low-conn <max>
14550 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14551 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14552 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14553 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14554 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14555 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14556 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14557 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14558 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14559 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014560 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14561 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14562 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14563 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014564
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014565pool-max-conn <max>
14566 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14567 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14568 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14569 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14570 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14571 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14572
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014573pool-purge-delay <delay>
14574 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014575 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014576 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014578port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014579 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014580 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14581 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14582 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14583 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14584 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014585
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014586proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014587 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14588 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14589 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014590 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14591 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14592
14593 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14594 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14595 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14596 also reported (flag=HTX).
14597
14598 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14599 a server line :
14600
14601 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14602 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14603 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14604 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14605
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014606 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014607 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014609redir <prefix>
14610 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14611 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14612 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14613 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14614 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14615 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14616 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14617 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014618 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014619 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014620 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14621 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14622 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14623 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14624
14625 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014627rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014628 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14629 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14630 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14631
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014632resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14633 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14634 server.
14635
14636 Available options:
14637
14638 * allow-dup-ip
14639 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14640 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14641 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14642 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14643 For such case, simply enable this option.
14644 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14645
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014646 * ignore-weight
14647 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14648 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14649 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14650
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014651 * prevent-dup-ip
14652 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14653 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14654 same fqdn.
14655 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14656
14657 Example:
14658 backend b_myapp
14659 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14660 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14661 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14662
14663 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14664 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14665 it
14666 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14667 different address
14668
14669 Default value: not set
14670
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014671resolve-prefer <family>
14672 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14673 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14674 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14675 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14676
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014677 Default value: ipv6
14678
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014679 Example:
14680
14681 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014682
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014683resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014684 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014685 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014686 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014687 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14688 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014689 configured network, another address is selected.
14690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014691 Example:
14692
14693 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014694
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014695resolvers <id>
14696 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14697 hostname.
14698
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014699 Example:
14700
14701 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014703 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014704
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014705send-proxy
14706 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14707 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14708 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14709 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014710 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14711 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14712 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14713 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14714 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14715 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14716 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14717 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14718 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14719 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014720 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14721 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014722
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014723send-proxy-v2
14724 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14725 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14726 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14727 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014728 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14729 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14730 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14731 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014732
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014733proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014734 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14735 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14736
14737 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14738 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14739 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14740 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14741 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14742 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14743 connection is supported).
14744 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14745 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14746 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14747 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14748 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14749 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14750 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014751
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014752send-proxy-v2-ssl
14753 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14754 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14755 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14756 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14757 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14758 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14759 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014760 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14761 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014762
14763send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14764 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14765 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14766 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14767 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14768 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14769 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14770 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14771 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014772 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14773 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014775slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014776 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14777 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14778 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14779 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14780 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14781 parameters :
14782
14783 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14784 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14785
14786 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14787 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14788 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14789 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14790
14791 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14792 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14793 seen as failed.
14794
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014795sni <expression>
14796 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14797 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14798 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14799 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014800 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14801 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014802 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014803 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14804 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014805
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014806source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014807source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014808source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14810 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14811 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14812 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14813
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014814 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14815 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14816 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14817 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14818 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14819 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14820 server.
14821
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014822 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14823 specifying the source address without port(s).
14824
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014825ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014826 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14827 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14828 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14829 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14830 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14831 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014832 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14833 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014834
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014835ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14836 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14837 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14838 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14839
14840ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14841 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14842 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14843 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14844
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014845ssl-reuse
14846 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14847 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14848 default value.
14849 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14850 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14851
14852stick
14853 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14854 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14855 default value.
14856 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14857 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014858
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014859socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014860 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014861 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14862 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14863
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014864tcp-ut <delay>
14865 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14866 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14867 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014868 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014869 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14870 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14871 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14872 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14873 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14874 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14875 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14876 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14877 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14878
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014879tfo
14880 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14881 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14882 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14883 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14884 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014885 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014887track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014888 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14889 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14890 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14891 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014892 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14893
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014894tls-tickets
14895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14897 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014898 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14899 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14900 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014901 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014902 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014903
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014904verify [none|required]
14905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014906 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014907 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14908 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014909 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014910 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14911 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14912 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14913 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14914 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14915 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14916 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14917 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014918
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014919verifyhost <hostname>
14920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014921 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14922 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14923 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14924 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14925 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14926 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14927 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14928 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014930weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014931 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14932 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14933 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014934 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14935 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14936 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14937 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14938 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14939 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014940
14941
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14943-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014944
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014945HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14946using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014947configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014948This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14949can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14950workload.
14951This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14952resolution at run time.
14953Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14954carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14955
14956
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149575.3.1. Global overview
14958----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014959
14960As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14961different steps of the process life:
14962
14963 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14964 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14965 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14966
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014967 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14968 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014969
14970A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14971 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14972 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14973 resolution to know this new IP.
14974
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014975When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014977SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14978from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14979will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14980will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014981
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014982A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014983 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014984 first valid response.
14985
14986 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14987 servers return an error.
14988
14989
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149905.3.2. The resolvers section
14991----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014992
14993This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014994HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14995contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014996
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014997When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14998uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14999is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15000answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15001
15002When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015003used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015004
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015005 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15006 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15007 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015008
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015009 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15010 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015011
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015012 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15013 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15014 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015015
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015016For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15017following scenarios are possible:
15018
15019 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15020 ignored
15021
15022 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15023 applied
15024
15025 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15026 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15027
15028 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15029 retries the query with a new type
15030
15031 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15032 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015033
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015034As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15035a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015036<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015037
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015038
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015039resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015040 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015041
15042A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15043
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015044accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015045 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015046 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015047 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15048 by RFC 6891)
15049
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015050 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15051 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15052 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15053 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15054 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15055 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015056
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015057nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15058 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15059 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15060 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15061 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15062 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15063 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15064 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15065 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15066 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015067 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15068
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015069parse-resolv-conf
15070 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15071 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15072 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015074hold <status> <period>
15075 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15076 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015077 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015078 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015079 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15080 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15081 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15082
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015083 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015084
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015085resolve_retries <nb>
15086 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15087 giving up.
15088 Default value: 3
15089
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015090 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15091 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15092 type.
15093
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015094timeout <event> <time>
15095 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15096 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15097 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015098 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15099 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015100 Default value: 1s
15101 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015102 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015103 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015104 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15105 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15106
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015107 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015108
15109 resolvers mydns
15110 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15111 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015112 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015113 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015114 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015115 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015116 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015117 hold other 30s
15118 hold refused 30s
15119 hold nx 30s
15120 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015121 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015122 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015123
15124
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151256. Cache
15126---------
15127
15128HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15129(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15130RAM.
15131
15132The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15133this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15134
15135If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15136independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15137when we try to allocate a new one.
15138
15139The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15140
15141It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15142"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15143for more details.
15144
15145When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15146replaced by "<CACHE>".
15147
15148
151496.1. Limitation
15150----------------
15151
15152The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15153
15154- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015155- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15156 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15157 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015158- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15159- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015160- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15161 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15162 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015163- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15164 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015165- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15166 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15167 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015168
15169- If the request is not a GET
15170- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15171- If the request contains an Authorization header
15172
15173
151746.2. Setup
15175-----------
15176
15177To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15178the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15179
15180
151816.2.1. Cache section
15182---------------------
15183
15184cache <name>
15185 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15186 size of cache is mandatory.
15187
15188total-max-size <megabytes>
15189 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15190 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15191
15192max-object-size <bytes>
15193 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15194 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15195 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15196
15197max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015198 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015199 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15200 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15201 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15202 default.
15203
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015204process-vary <on/off>
15205 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015206 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15207 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15208 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015209 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015210
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015211max-secondary-entries <number>
15212 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15213 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15214 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15215
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015216
152176.2.2. Proxy section
15218---------------------
15219
15220http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15221 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15222 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15223 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15224 after this one.
15225
15226http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15227 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15228 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15229 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15230 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15231
15232
15233Example:
15234
15235 backend bck1
15236 mode http
15237
15238 http-request cache-use foobar
15239 http-response cache-store foobar
15240 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15241
15242 cache foobar
15243 total-max-size 4
15244 max-age 240
15245
15246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15248----------------------------------
15249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015250HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15252The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15253these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15254but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15255data called patterns.
15256
15257
152587.1. ACL basics
15259---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015260
15261The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15262content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15263from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15264simple :
15265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015267 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15269 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15272adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015273
15274In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015277
15278This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15279Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15280and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015281an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15282conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15283as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15284are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015285
15286ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15287'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15288which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15289
15290There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15291performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015293The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15294specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15295this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015296methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15297ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015298
15299Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15300 - boolean
15301 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15302 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15303 - string
15304 - data block
15305
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015306Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15307converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15308would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15309The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15310which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15311
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015312Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15313keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15314fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15315which are summarized in the table below :
15316
15317 +---------------------+-----------------+
15318 | Sample or converter | Default |
15319 | output type | matching method |
15320 +---------------------+-----------------+
15321 | boolean | bool |
15322 +---------------------+-----------------+
15323 | integer | int |
15324 +---------------------+-----------------+
15325 | ip | ip |
15326 +---------------------+-----------------+
15327 | string | str |
15328 +---------------------+-----------------+
15329 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15330 +---------------------+-----------------+
15331
15332Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15333matching method, see below.
15334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15336 - boolean
15337 - integer or integer range
15338 - IP address / network
15339 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15340 - regular expression
15341 - hex block
15342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015343The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15344
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015345 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15346 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015348 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015349 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015350 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015351 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15354read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15355if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15356lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15357will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15358beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15359a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15360lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15361exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15362
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015363The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15364parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15365ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15366a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15367check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15368
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015369The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15370socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15371file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15374loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15375
15376 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15377
15378In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15379the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15380case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15381as well.
15382
15383The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15384sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15385do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15386methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15387is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015388obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015389followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15390default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15391that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15392string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15393
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015394The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15395By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15396string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15397resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15398server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015399waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015400flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15401function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15404sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15405be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015406
15407 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15408 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15410 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15411 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15412 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015413
15414 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15415 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015417
15418 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015420
15421 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015423
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015424 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015425 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15426
15427 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15428 binary or string samples.
15429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15431 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15434 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15435 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15438 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15441 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15444 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15447 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015448 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15451 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15452 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015453
15454For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15455request, it is possible to do :
15456
15457 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15458
15459In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15460buffer, one would use the following acl :
15461
15462 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15463
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015464On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15465possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15466
15467 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15470criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15471method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15472to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15473criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15474the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015477the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15478For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15481 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15482 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15483 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015484
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015485
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015486The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15487types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15488combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15489brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15490default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 +-------------------------------------------------+
15493 | Input sample type |
15494 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015495 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15497 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15498 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015499 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015501 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015503 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015505 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015507 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015509 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015511 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015513 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015515 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015517 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015519 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15521 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15522 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015523
15524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155257.1.1. Matching booleans
15526------------------------
15527
15528In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15529Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15530When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15531that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15532
15533Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15534return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15535"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155387.1.2. Matching integers
15539------------------------
15540
15541Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15542enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15543to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15544
15545Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15546matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15547lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015548
15549For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15550unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15551representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15552
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015553As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15554two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15555instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15556ranges and operators.
15557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015558For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015559operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15560Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15561of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015563Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015564
15565 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15566 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15567 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15568 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15569 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15570
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015571For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015572
15573 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15574
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015575This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15576
15577 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155807.1.3. Matching strings
15581-----------------------
15582
15583String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15584different forms :
15585
15586 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015587 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588
15589 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015590 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591
15592 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15593 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15594
15595 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15596 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15597
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015598 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15600 matches.
15601
15602 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15603 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15604 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015605
15606String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15607exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15608characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15609string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15610to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015611before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015612
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015613Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15614(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15615Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15616
15617Example:
15618 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15619 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156227.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15623---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015624
15625Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15626they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15627possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15628passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15629the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015630the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15631match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015632
15633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156347.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15635-------------------------------------
15636
15637It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15638not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15639a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15640to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15641digits may be used upper or lower case.
15642
15643Example :
15644 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15645 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15646
15647
156487.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15649---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015650
15651IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15652netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15653within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015654host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015655difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15656at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15657does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15658parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015659
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015660The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15661abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15662
15663 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15664 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15665 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15666 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15667 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15668 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15669 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15670 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15671
15672Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15673192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15674
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015675IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15676Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15677trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15678IPv6 patterns.
15679
15680HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15681following situations :
15682 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15683 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15684 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15685 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15686 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15687 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15688 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15689 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15690 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15691 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693
156947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15695----------------------------------
15696
15697Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15698combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15699
15700 - AND (implicit)
15701 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15702 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15709indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15712"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15713requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15714is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15715
15716 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015717 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15718 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15719 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720
15721To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15722and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15723
15724 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15725 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15726 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15727 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015729 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15731 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15732 use_backend www if host_www
15733
15734It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15735expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15736be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15737the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15738
15739 The following rule :
15740
15741 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015742 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743
15744 Can also be written that way :
15745
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015746 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747
15748It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15749to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15750simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15751sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15752good use is the following :
15753
15754 With named ACLs :
15755
15756 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15757 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15758 monitor fail if site_dead
15759
15760 With anonymous ACLs :
15761
15762 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15763
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015764See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15765keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766
15767
157687.3. Fetching samples
15769---------------------
15770
15771Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15772against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15773sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15774ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15775of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15776available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15777
15778This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15779Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15780compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15781deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15782
15783The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15784matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15785method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15786indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15787
15788As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15789when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15790mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15791the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15792ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15793
15794Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15795multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15796when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015797incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15798are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15800all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15801
15802Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15803 - name
15804 - name(arg1)
15805 - name(arg1,arg2)
15806
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015807
158087.3.1. Converters
15809-----------------
15810
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015811Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15812of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15813is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15814was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015815has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015816unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15817
15818These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15819sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15820the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015821support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015822
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015823A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15824support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15825supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15826(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15827bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015830
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001583151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15832 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15833 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15834 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15835 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15836 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15837
15838 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015839 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15840 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015841 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15842 frontend http-in
15843 bind *:8081
15844 default_backend servers
15845 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15846 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015848add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015849 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015850 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015851 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15852 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015853 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015854 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15855 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15857 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015858 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015859 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015860
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015861aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15862 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15863 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15864 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15865 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15866 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15867 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15868
15869 Example:
15870 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15871 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15872
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015873and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015874 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015875 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015876 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15877 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15881 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15882 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015883 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015884 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015885
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015886b64dec
15887 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15888 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015889 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15890 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015891
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015892base64
15893 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015894 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015895 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15896 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015897
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015898bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015899 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015900 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015901 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015902 presence of a flag).
15903
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015904bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15905 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15906 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015907 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015908
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015909concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15910 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15911 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15912 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15913 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15914 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15915 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15916 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15917 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15918 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15919 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015920 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015921 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015922 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15923 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015924
15925 Example:
15926 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15927 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15928 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015929 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015930 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015932cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015933 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15934 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015935
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015936crc32([<avalanche>])
15937 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15938 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15939 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15940 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15941 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15942 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15943 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15944 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15945 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15946 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015947 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15948
15949crc32c([<avalanche>])
15950 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15951 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15952 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15953 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15954 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15955 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15956 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15957 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015958
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015959cut_crlf
15960 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15961 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15962 updated.
15963
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015964da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015965 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15966 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15967 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15968 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015969 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015970 configuration language.
15971
15972 Example:
15973 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015974 bind *:8881
15975 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015976 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015977
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015978debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15979 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15980 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15981 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15982 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15983 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15984 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15985 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15986 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15987 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15988 printable sample types.
15989
15990 Example:
15991 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015992
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015993digest(<algorithm>)
15994 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15995 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15996
15997 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15998 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15999
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016000div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016001 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16002 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016003 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016004 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16005 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16010 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016011 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016012 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016013
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016014djb2([<avalanche>])
16015 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16016 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16017 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16018 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16019 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16020 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16021 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016022 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16023 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016025even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016026 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016027 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16028
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016029field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16030 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16031 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16032 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16033 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16034 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16035 fields.
16036
16037 Example :
16038 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16041 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16042 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016043
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016044fix_is_valid
16045 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16046 Information eXchange):
16047
16048 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16049 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016050 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016051 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016052 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016053 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16054 checksum
16055
16056 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16057 the server can be parsed.
16058
16059 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16060 message, false if not.
16061
16062 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16063
16064 Example:
16065 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16066 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16067
16068fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16069 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16070 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16071 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16072 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016073 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016074 added.
16075
16076 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16077 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16078 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16079 fix_is_valid converter.
16080
16081 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16082
16083 Example:
16084 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16085 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16086 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16087 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16088 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16089
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016090hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016091 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016092 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016093 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016094 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016095
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016096hex2i
16097 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016098 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016099
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016100htonl
16101 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16102 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16103 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16104 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16105
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016106hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016107 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16108 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16109 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16110 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16111
16112 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16113 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16114
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016115http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016116 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16117 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016118 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16119 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16120 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16121 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16122 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16123 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16124 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16125 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016127iif(<true>,<false>)
16128 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16129 string otherwise.
16130
16131 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016132 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016133
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016134in_table(<table>)
16135 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16136 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16137 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016138 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016139 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16140
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016141ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016142 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016143 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016144 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16145 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16146 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16147 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16148 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016149
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016150json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016151 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016152 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016153 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016154 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16155 of errors:
16156 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16157 bytes, ...)
16158 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16159 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16160
16161 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16162 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16163 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16164 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16165 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16166 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016167 - "ascii" : never fails;
16168 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16169 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016170 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016171 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016172 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16173 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16174
16175 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016176 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016177
16178 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016179 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016180 capture request header user-agent len 150
16181 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016182
16183 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16184 GET / HTTP/1.0
16185 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16186
16187 Output log:
16188 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16189
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016190json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16191 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16192 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16193 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16194 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16195
16196 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16197 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16198
16199 Example:
16200 # get a integer value from the request body
16201 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16202 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16203
16204 # get a key with '.' in the name
16205 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16206 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16207
16208 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16209 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16210
16211 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16212 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016214language(<value>[,<default>])
16215 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16216 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16217 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16218 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16219 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16220 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16221 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16222 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16223 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016224 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016225 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16226 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016228 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016229
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016230 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16231 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016232
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016233 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16234 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16235 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16236 use_backend spanish if es
16237 use_backend french if fr
16238 use_backend english if en
16239 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016240
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016241length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016242 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16243 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16244 type. The result is of type integer.
16245
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016246lower
16247 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16248 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16249 type. The result is of type string.
16250
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016251ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16252 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16253 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16254 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16255 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16256 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16257 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16258
16259 Example :
16260
16261 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016262 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016263 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16264
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016265ltrim(<chars>)
16266 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16267 representation of the input sample.
16268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016269map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16270map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16271map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16272 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16273 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16274 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16275 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16276 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16277 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16278 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16279 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016281 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16282 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16283 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016284
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016285 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016286 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016287
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016288 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16289 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16290 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16291 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016292 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16293 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016294 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16295 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16296 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16297 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16298 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16299 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16300 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16301 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016302 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16303 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16304 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016305 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16306 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16307 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16308 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016310
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016311 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16312 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16313 the corresponding match text.
16314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016315 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16316 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16317 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16318 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16319 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016320
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016321 Example :
16322
16323 # this is a comment and is ignored
16324 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16325 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16326 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16327 | | | `---------- value
16328 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16329 | `---------------------------- key
16330 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16331
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016332mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016333 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16334 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016335 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016336 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016337 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016338 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16339 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016343 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016344
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016345mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016346 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16347 <packettype>.
16348 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16349 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16350 from.
16351 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16352 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16353 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16354
16355 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16356 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16357 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16358 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16359
16360 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16361 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16362 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16363 packets only):
16364 17: Session Expiry Interval
16365 33: Receive Maximum
16366 39: Maximum Packet Size
16367 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16368 25: Request Response Information
16369 23: Request Problem Information
16370 21: Authentication Method
16371 22: Authentication Data
16372 18: Will Delay Interval
16373 1: Payload Format Indicator
16374 2: Message Expiry Interval
16375 3: Content Type
16376 8: Response Topic
16377 9: Correlation Data
16378 Not supported yet:
16379 38: User Property
16380
16381 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16382 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16383 packets only):
16384 17: Session Expiry Interval
16385 33: Receive Maximum
16386 36: Maximum QoS
16387 37: Retain Available
16388 39: Maximum Packet Size
16389 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16390 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16391 31: Reason String
16392 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16393 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16394 42: Shared Subscription Available
16395 19: Server Keep Alive
16396 26: Response Information
16397 28: Server Reference
16398 21: Authentication Method
16399 22: Authentication Data
16400 Not supported yet:
16401 38: User Property
16402
16403 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16404 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16405 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16406 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16407
16408 Example:
16409
16410 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16411 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16412 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16413 if data_in_buffer
16414 # do the same as above
16415 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16416 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16417 if data_in_buffer
16418
16419mqtt_is_valid
16420 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16421
16422 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16423 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16424 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16425 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16426
16427 Example:
16428
16429 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16430 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16431
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016432mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016433 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016434 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16435 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016436 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016437 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016438 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016439 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16440 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16441 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16442 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016443 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016444 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016445
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016446nbsrv
16447 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16448 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16449 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16450 map lookup.
16451
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016452neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016453 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16454 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16455 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16456 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016457
16458not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016459 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016460 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016461 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016462 absence of a flag).
16463
16464odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016465 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016466 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16467
16468or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016469 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016470 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016471 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16472 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016480
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016481protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16482 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16483 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16484 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16485 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16486 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16487 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16488 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16489 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16490 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16491 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16492 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16493
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016494regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016495 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16496 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16497 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16498 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16499 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16500 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16501 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16502 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16503 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016504 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16505 of characters with other ones.
16506
16507 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16508 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16509 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16510 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16511 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16512 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016513
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016514 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016515
16516 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16517 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16518 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016519 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016520
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016521 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16522 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16523
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016524 # capture groups and backreferences
16525 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016526 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016527 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16528
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016529capture-req(<id>)
16530 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16531 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16532
16533 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016534 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16535 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016536
16537capture-res(<id>)
16538 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16539 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16540
16541 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016542 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16543 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016544
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016545rtrim(<chars>)
16546 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16547 of the input sample.
16548
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016549sdbm([<avalanche>])
16550 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16551 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16552 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16553 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16554 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16555 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16556 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016557 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16558 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016559
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016560secure_memcmp(<var>)
16561 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16562 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16563 match.
16564
16565 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16566 performed in constant time.
16567
16568 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16569 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16570
16571 Example :
16572
16573 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16574 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16575 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16576 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16577
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016578set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16580 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16581 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016582 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016583 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16584 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016585 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016586 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16587 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016588 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016589 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016590
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016591sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016592 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016593 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16594
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016595sha2([<bits>])
16596 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16597 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16598
16599 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16600 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16601
16602 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16603 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16604
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016605srv_queue
16606 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16607 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16608 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16609 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16610 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16611
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016612strcmp(<var>)
16613 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16614 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16615 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16616 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16617 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16618 shorter).
16619
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016620 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16621 strings in constant time.
16622
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016623 Example :
16624
16625 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16626 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16627 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16628
16629
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016630sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016631 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16632 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016633 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016634 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16635 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016636 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016637 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16638 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016639 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016640 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16641 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016642 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016643 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016644
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016645table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16646 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16647 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16648 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16649 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16650 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16651 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16652
16653
16654table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16657 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16658 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16659 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16660 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16661
16662table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016665 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016666 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16667 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16668
16669table_conn_cur(<table>)
16670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16672 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16673 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16674 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16675
16676table_conn_rate(<table>)
16677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16680 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16681 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16682
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016683table_gpt0(<table>)
16684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16687 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16688 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16689
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016690table_gpc0(<table>)
16691 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16692 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16693 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16694 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16695 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16696
16697table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16698 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16699 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16700 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16701 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16702 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16703 sample fetch keyword.
16704
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016705table_gpc1(<table>)
16706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16709 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16710 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16711
16712table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16716 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16717 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16718 sample fetch keyword.
16719
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016720table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016724 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16725 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16726
16727table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16730 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16731 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16732 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16733 keyword.
16734
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016735table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16739 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16740 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16741
16742table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16745 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16746 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16747 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16748 keyword.
16749
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016750table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16751 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16752 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016753 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016754 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16755 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16756
16757table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16760 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16761 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16762 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16763 keyword.
16764
16765table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016769 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16770 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16771 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16772 keyword.
16773
16774table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016777 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016778 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16779 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16780 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16781 keyword.
16782
16783table_server_id(<table>)
16784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16787 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16788 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16789 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16790
16791table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016795 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16796 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16797 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16798 keyword.
16799
16800table_sess_rate(<table>)
16801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16804 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16805 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16806 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16807 keyword.
16808
16809table_trackers(<table>)
16810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16812 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16813 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16814 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16815 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16816 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16817 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16818 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16819 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16820
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016821ub64dec
16822 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16823 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16824 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16825
16826 Example:
16827 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16828 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16829
16830ub64enc
16831 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16832
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016833upper
16834 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16835 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16836 type. The result is of type string.
16837
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016838url_dec([<in_form>])
16839 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16840 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16841 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16842 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16843 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16844 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016845
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016846url_enc([<enc_type>])
16847 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16848 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16849 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16850 optional argument is here for future changes.
16851
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016852ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016853 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016854 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16855 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16856 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016857 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16858 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16859 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16860 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016861 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016862 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16863 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016864
16865 Example:
16866 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16867 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16868
16869 message Point {
16870 int32 latitude = 1;
16871 int32 longitude = 2;
16872 }
16873
16874 message PPoint {
16875 Point point = 59;
16876 }
16877
16878 message Rectangle {
16879 // One corner of the rectangle.
16880 PPoint lo = 48;
16881 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16882 PPoint hi = 49;
16883 }
16884
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016885 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16886 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16887 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016888
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016889 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16890 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016891 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016892 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16893
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016894 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016895
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016896 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016897
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016898 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16899 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16900 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016901
16902 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16903 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16904 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16905
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016906 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16907 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16908 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016909
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016910
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016911unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016912 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16913 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16916 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16917 response),
16918 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16919 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16920 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16921 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16922
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016923utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16924 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16925 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16926 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16927 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16928 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16929 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16930
16931 Example :
16932
16933 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016934 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016935 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16936
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016937word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16938 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16939 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16940 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016941 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016942 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16943 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16944
16945 Example :
16946 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16947 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16948 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16949 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16950 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016951 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016952
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016953wt6([<avalanche>])
16954 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16955 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16956 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16957 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16958 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16959 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16960 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016961 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16962 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016963
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016964xor(<value>)
16965 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016966 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016967 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016968 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16971 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016972 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016973 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16974 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016975 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016976 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016977
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016978xxh3([<seed>])
16979 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16980 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16981 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16982 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16983 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16984 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16985 considered as cryptographically secure.
16986
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016987xxh32([<seed>])
16988 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16989 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16990 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16991 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16992 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16993 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16994 as cryptographically secure.
16995
16996xxh64([<seed>])
16997 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16998 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16999 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17000 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17001 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17002 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17003 as cryptographically secure.
17004
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017005
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170067.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017007--------------------------------------------
17008
17009A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17010not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17011"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17012The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17013
17014always_false : boolean
17015 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17016 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17017
17018always_true : boolean
17019 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17020 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17021
17022avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017023 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17025 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17026 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17027 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17028 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17029 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17030 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17031 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17032 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17033 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17034 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17035 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17036 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017038be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017039 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17040 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17041 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17042 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017043 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17044
17045be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17047 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17048 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17049 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17050 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017051 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17052 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017053
17054 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17055 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17056 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17059 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17060 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17061 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017062 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17064 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017065
17066 Example :
17067 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17068 backend dynamic
17069 mode http
17070 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17071 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017073bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017074 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17075 of the string.
17076
17077bool(<bool>) : bool
17078 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17079 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17082 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017083 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017084 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17085 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017086
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017087 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017088 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017089 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17090
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017091 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17092 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017093
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017094 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017095 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017097 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017098 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017099 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017100 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017101
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017102 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17103 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017104 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017105 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017106
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017107cpu_calls : integer
17108 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17109 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17110 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17111 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17112 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17113 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17114
17115cpu_ns_avg : integer
17116 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17117 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17118 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17119 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17120 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17121 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17122 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17123 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17124 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17125 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17126 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17127
17128cpu_ns_tot : integer
17129 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17130 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17131 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17132 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17133 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17134 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17135 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17136 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17137 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17138 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17139 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17140 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17141 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17142
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017143date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017144 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017145
17146 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17147 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17148 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017149 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17150
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017151 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17152 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17153 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17154 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17155 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17156
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017157 Example :
17158
17159 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17160 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017161
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017162 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17163 # millisecond granularity
17164 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17165
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017166date_us : integer
17167 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17168 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17169 from the same timeval structure.
17170
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017171distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17172 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17173 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17174 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17175 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17176 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17177 list of supported tokens.
17178
17179distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17180 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17181 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17182 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17183 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17184 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17185 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17186 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17187 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17188 supported tokens.
17189
17190 Example :
17191 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17192 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17193 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17194 # send large files to the big farm
17195 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17196
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017197env(<name>) : string
17198 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17199 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17200 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17201 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17202 certain way.
17203
17204 Examples :
17205 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17206 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17207
17208 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17209 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17212 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017213 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17214 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017215 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17216 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017217 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17219 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017220
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017221fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17222 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17223 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17224 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17228 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17229 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17230 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17231 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17232 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17233 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17234 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017235
17236 Example :
17237 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17238 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17239 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17240 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17241 frontend mail
17242 bind :25
17243 mode tcp
17244 maxconn 100
17245 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17246 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17247 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17248 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017249
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017250hostname : string
17251 Returns the system hostname.
17252
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017253int(<integer>) : signed integer
17254 Returns a signed integer.
17255
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017256ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17257 Returns an ipv4.
17258
17259ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17260 Returns an ipv6.
17261
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017262lat_ns_avg : integer
17263 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17264 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17265 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17266 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17267 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17268 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17269 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17270 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17271 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017272 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17273 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17274 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17275 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17276 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17277 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017278
17279lat_ns_tot : integer
17280 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17281 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17282 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17283 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17284 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17285 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17286 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17287 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17288 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017289 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17290 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17291 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17292 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17293 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017294 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17295 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17296 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17297 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17298 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17299 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17300
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017301meth(<method>) : method
17302 Returns a method.
17303
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017304nbproc : integer
17305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17306 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17307 and debugging purposes.
17308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17310 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17311 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17312 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017313 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17314 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17315 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017316
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017317prio_class : integer
17318 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17319 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17320 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17321
17322prio_offset : integer
17323 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17324 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17325 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17326 set-priority-offset".
17327
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017328proc : integer
17329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17330 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17331 debugging purposes.
17332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017334 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17335 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17336 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017337 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17338 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17339 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17340 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17341 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17342
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017343rand([<range>]) : integer
17344 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17345 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17346 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17347 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17348 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17349
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017350uuid([<version>]) : string
17351 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17352 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17353 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17357 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17358 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17359 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17360 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017361 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17362 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17363
17364srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17365 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17366 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17367 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17368 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17369 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17370 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17371 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17372
17373 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17374 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375
17376srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17377 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17378 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17379 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017380 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17382 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17383 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17384
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017385srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17387 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17388 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17389 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17390 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17391 fetch methods.
17392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17394 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17395 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017396 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17398 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017399 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400 overloading servers).
17401
17402 Example :
17403 # Redirect to a separate back
17404 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17405 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17406 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17407
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017408srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017409 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17410 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17411 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17412
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017413srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017414 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17415 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17416 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17417
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017418srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017419 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17420 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17421 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17422
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017423stopping : boolean
17424 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17425 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17426 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17427
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017428str(<string>) : string
17429 Returns a string.
17430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17432 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17433 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17434
17435table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17436 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17437 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17438 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17439
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017440thread : integer
17441 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17442 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17443 and debugging purposes.
17444
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017445var(<var-name>) : undefined
17446 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017447 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17448 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017449 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017450 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17451 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017452 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017453 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17454 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017455 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017456 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017457
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174587.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459----------------------------------
17460
17461The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17462closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17463methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17464sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17465TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017466the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17467counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017468"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17469used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17470can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17471Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17472table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17473tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17474currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017475
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017476bc_dst : ip
17477 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17478 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17479 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17480 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17481
17482bc_dst_port : integer
17483 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17484 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17485
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017486bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017487 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17488 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17489 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17490
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017491bc_src : ip
17492 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17493 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17494 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17495 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17496
17497bc_src_port : integer
17498 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17499 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017501be_id : integer
17502 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017503 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17504 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017505
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017506be_name : string
17507 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017508 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17509 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017510
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017511be_server_timeout : integer
17512 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17513 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17514 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17515
17516be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17517 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17518 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17519 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17520
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017521cur_server_timeout : integer
17522 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17523 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17524 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17525
17526cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17527 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17528 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17529 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531dst : ip
17532 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17533 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17534 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17535 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017536 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17537 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17538 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17539 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17540 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17541 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017542
17543dst_conn : integer
17544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17545 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17546 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17547 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17548 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17549 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17550 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17551 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017552
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017553dst_is_local : boolean
17554 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17555 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17556 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17557 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017558 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017559 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17560 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17561 it only once per connection.
17562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563dst_port : integer
17564 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17565 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17566 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17567 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17568 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17569 an HTTP header.
17570
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017571fc_http_major : integer
17572 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17573 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17574 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17575
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017576fc_pp_authority : string
17577 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17578 if any.
17579
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017580fc_pp_unique_id : string
17581 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17582 if any.
17583
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017584fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17585 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17586 header.
17587
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017588fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17589 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17590 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17591 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17592 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17593 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17594 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17595
17596fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17597 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17598 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17599 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17600 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17601 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17602 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17603
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017604fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017605 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17606 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17607 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17608 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17609
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017610fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017611 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17612 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17613 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17614 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17615
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017616fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017617 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17618 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17619 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17620 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17621
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017622fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017623 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17624 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17625 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17626 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17627
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017628fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017629 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17630 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17631 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17632 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17633
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017634fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017635 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17636 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17637 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17638 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17639
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017640fe_defbe : string
17641 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17642 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644fe_id : integer
17645 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017646 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17648
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017649fe_name : string
17650 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17651 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17652 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17653
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017654fe_client_timeout : integer
17655 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17656 current frontend.
17657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017658sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017659sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17660sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17661sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017662 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17663 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17664 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017666sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017667sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17668sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17669sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017670 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17671 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17672 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17673
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017674sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017675sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17676sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17677sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017678 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17679 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017680 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17681 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17682 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017683
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017684 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017685 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17686 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017687 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17688 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17689 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017690 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17691 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17692
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017693sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17694sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17695sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17696sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17697 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17698 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17699 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17700 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17701 when a first ACL was verified.
17702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017703sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017704sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17705sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17706sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017707 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017708 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017710sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017711sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17712sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17713sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017714 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17715 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17716 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017718sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017719sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17720sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17721sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017722 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17723 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17724 See also src_conn_rate.
17725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017726sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017727sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17728sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17729sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017730 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017731 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017732
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017733sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17734sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17735sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17736sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17737 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17738 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17739
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017740sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17741sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17742sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17743sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17744 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17745 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17746
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017747sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017748sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17749sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17750sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017751 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17752 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17753 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017754 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17755 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17756 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017757
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017758sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17759sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17760sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17761sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17762 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17763 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17764 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17765 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17766 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17767 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017769sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017770sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17771sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17772sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017773 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017774 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17775 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017777sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017778sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17779sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17780sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017781 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17782 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17783 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17784 src_http_err_rate.
17785
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017786sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17787sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17788sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17789sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17790 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17791 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17792 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17793
17794sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17795sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17796sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17797sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17798 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17799 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17800 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17801 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017803sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017804sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17805sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17806sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017807 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017808 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17809 src_http_req_cnt.
17810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017811sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017812sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17813sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17814sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017815 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17816 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17817 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17818 src_http_req_rate.
17819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017820sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017821sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17822sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17823sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017824 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017825 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17826 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17827 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17828 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017829
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017830 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017831 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17832 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017833 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17834
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017835sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17836sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17837sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17838sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17839 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17840 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17841 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17842 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17843 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017845sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017846sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17847sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17848sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017849 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17850 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17851 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017853sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017854sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17855sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17856sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017857 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17858 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17859 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017861sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017862sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17863sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17864sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017865 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017866 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17867 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17868 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017869 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017870 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017872sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017873sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17874sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17875sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017876 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17877 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17878 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17879 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17880 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017881 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017883sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017884sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17885sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17886sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017887 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17888 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17889 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17890
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017891sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017892sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17893sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17894sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017895 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17896 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017897 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017898 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17899 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17901 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17902 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017904so_id : integer
17905 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17906 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17907 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017908
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017909so_name : string
17910 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17911 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17912 strings instead of integers.
17913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017914src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017915 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017916 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17917 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17918 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017919 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17920 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17921 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017922 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17923 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17924 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17925 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17926 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17927 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17928 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017929
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017930 Example:
17931 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17932 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17935 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17936 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17937 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017938 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017940src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17941 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17942 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017943 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017944 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17947 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17948 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17949 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17950 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17951 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17952 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017953
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017954 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017955 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17956 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17957 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17958 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017959 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017960 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17961 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17962
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017963src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17964 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17965 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17966 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17967 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17968 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17969 was verified.
17970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017972 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017974 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017975 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017977src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017978 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17980 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017981 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17984 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17985 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17986 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017987 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017990 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017991 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017992 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017993 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017994
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017995src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17996 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17997 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17998 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17999 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18000
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018001src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18002 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18003 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18004 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18005 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018007src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018008 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018009 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018010 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18011 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018012 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18013 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18014 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018015
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018016src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18017 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18018 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18019 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18020 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18021 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18022 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18023 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018026 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018027 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018028 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018029 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018032src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18033 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18034 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18035 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18036 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018037 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018038
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018039src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18040 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18041 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018042 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018043 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18044 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18045
18046src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18047 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18048 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18049 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18050 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18051 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18052 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018054src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018055 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018056 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18057 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018058 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18061 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18062 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18063 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018064 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018065 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18068 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18069 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18070 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018071 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018072 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18073 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018074
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018075 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018076 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018077 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018078 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018079
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018080src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18081 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18082 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18083 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18084 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18085 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18086 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18087
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018088src_is_local : boolean
18089 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18090 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18091 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18092 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018093 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018094 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18095 once per connection.
18096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018098 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18099 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18100 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18101 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18102 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018104src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018105 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18106 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18107 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18108 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18109 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018111src_port : integer
18112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18113 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18114 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18115 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018118 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018119 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18120 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18121 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018122 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018124src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18125 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18126 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18127 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18128 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018129 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18132 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18133 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18134 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18135 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18136 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18137 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18138 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18139 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018140
18141 Example :
18142 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18143 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18144 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18145 listen ssh
18146 bind :22
18147 mode tcp
18148 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018149 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018151 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153srv_id : integer
18154 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18155 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018156 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018157
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018158srv_name : string
18159 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18160 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018161 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181637.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018164----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18167closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18168when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18169usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018170future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018171
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001817251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18173 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18174 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18175 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18176 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18177 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18178
18179 Example :
18180 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18181 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18182 # the request.
18183 frontend http-in
18184 bind *:8081
18185 default_backend servers
18186 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18187 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18188
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018189ssl_bc : boolean
18190 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18191 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018192 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18193 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018194
18195ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18196 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018197 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18198 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018199
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018200ssl_bc_alpn : string
18201 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18202 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018203 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018204 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18205 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18206 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18207 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18208 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018209 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18210 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018211
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018212ssl_bc_cipher : string
18213 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018214 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18215 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018216
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018217ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18218 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18219 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18220 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018221 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018222
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018223ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18224 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18225 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018226 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18227 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018228
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018229ssl_bc_npn : string
18230 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18231 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018232 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018233 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18234 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18235 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18236 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018237 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18238 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018239
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018240ssl_bc_protocol : string
18241 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018242 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18243 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018244
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018245ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018246 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018247 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018248 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18249 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018250
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018251ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18252 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18253 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18254 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018255 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018256
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018257ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18258 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18259 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018260 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18261 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018262
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018263ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18264 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18265 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18266 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018267 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018268
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018269ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18270 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018271 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18272 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18275 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18276 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18277 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18278 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18279 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18282 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18283 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18284 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18285 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018286
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018287ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018288 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18289 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18290 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018291 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018292 does not support resumed sessions.
18293
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018294ssl_c_der : binary
18295 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18296 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18297 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018299ssl_c_err : integer
18300 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18301 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18302 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18303 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18304 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018305
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018306ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18308 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18309 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18310 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18311 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18312 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18313 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18314 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018315 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18316 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18317 LDAP v3.
18318 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18319 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321ssl_c_key_alg : string
18322 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18323 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18324 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018326ssl_c_notafter : string
18327 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18328 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18329 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018331ssl_c_notbefore : string
18332 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18333 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18334 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018335
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018336ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18338 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18339 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18340 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18341 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18342 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18343 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18344 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018345 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18346 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18347 LDAP v3.
18348 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18349 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018351ssl_c_serial : binary
18352 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18353 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18354 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018356ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18357 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18358 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18359 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018360 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18361 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18362
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018363 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018364 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18367 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18368 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18369 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371ssl_c_used : boolean
18372 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18373 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375ssl_c_verify : integer
18376 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18377 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18378 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18379 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381ssl_c_version : integer
18382 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18383 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018384
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018385ssl_f_der : binary
18386 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18387 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18388 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18389
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018390ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018391 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18392 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18393 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18394 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018395 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18397 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18398 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018399 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18400 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18401 LDAP v3.
18402 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18403 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405ssl_f_key_alg : string
18406 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18407 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18408 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018410ssl_f_notafter : string
18411 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18412 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18413 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415ssl_f_notbefore : string
18416 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18417 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18418 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018419
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018420ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18422 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18423 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18424 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18425 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18426 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18427 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18428 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018429 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18430 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18431 LDAP v3.
18432 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18433 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018435ssl_f_serial : binary
18436 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18437 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18438 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018439
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018440ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18441 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18442 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18443 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18446 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18447 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18448 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018450ssl_f_version : integer
18451 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18452 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18453
18454ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018455 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18456 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18457 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018459 Example :
18460 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18461 listen http-https
18462 bind :80
18463 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18464 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18465
18466ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18467 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18468 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18469
18470ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018471 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18473 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18474 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18475 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18476 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18477 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18478 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18479 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481ssl_fc_cipher : string
18482 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18483 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018484
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018485ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18486 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18487 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018488 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018489
18490ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18491 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18492 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018493 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018494
18495ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18496 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18497 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18498 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018499 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018500 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018501
18502ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18503 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18504 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018505 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018506
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018507ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18508 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18509 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18510 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18511
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018512ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18513 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18514 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18515 transport layer.
18516 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18517 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18518 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18519 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18520
18521ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18522 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18523 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18524 transport layer.
18525 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18526 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18527 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18528 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18529
18530ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18531 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18532 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18533 transport layer.
18534 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18535 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18536 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18537 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18538
18539ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18540 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18541 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18542 transport layer.
18543 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18544 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18545 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18546 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18547
18548ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18549 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18550 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18551 transport layer.
18552 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18553 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18554 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18555 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018557ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018558 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18559 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018560 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18561 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18562 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18563 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018564
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018565ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18566 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18567 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18568 wait until the handshake happened.
18569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18571 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018572 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18573 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018574 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018575 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018576
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018577ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018578 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018579 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18580 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018582ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018583 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018584 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18585 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18586 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18587 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18588 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18589 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18590 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592ssl_fc_protocol : string
18593 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18594 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018595
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018596ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018597 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018598 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18599 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018600
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018601ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18602 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18603 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18604 transport layer.
18605 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18606 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18607 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18608 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18609
18610ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18611 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18612 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18613 transport layer.
18614 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18615 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18616 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18617 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18618
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018619ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18620 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18621 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18622 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018624ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18625 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18626 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18627 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18628 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018629
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018630ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18631 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18632 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18633 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18634 BoringSSL.
18635
18636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018637ssl_fc_sni : string
18638 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18639 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18640 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18641 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18642 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18643
18644 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18645 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18646 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018647 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018648 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018651 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18652 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018654ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18655 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18656 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018657
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018658ssl_s_der : binary
18659 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18660 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18661 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18662
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018663ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18664 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18665 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18666 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018667 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018668 does not support resumed sessions.
18669
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018670ssl_s_key_alg : string
18671 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18672 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18673 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18674
18675ssl_s_notafter : string
18676 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18677 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18678 transport layer.
18679
18680ssl_s_notbefore : string
18681 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18682 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18683 transport layer.
18684
18685ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18686 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18687 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18688 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18689 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18690 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18691 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018692 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18693 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018694 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18695 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18696 LDAP v3.
18697 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18698 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18699
18700ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18701 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18702 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18703 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18704 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18705 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18706 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018707 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18708 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018709 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18710 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18711 LDAP v3.
18712 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18713 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18714
18715ssl_s_serial : binary
18716 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18717 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18718 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18719
18720ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18721 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18722 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18723 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18724
18725ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18726 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18727 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18728 layer.
18729
18730ssl_s_version : integer
18731 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18732 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018733
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187347.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018737Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18738sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18739only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18740For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18741be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18742can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18743sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18744for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18745content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018746
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018747Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18748 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18749 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18750 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18751 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18752 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18753 sample expression). So be careful.
18754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018756 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18758 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018760payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18761 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018762 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018763 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765req.len : integer
18766req_len : integer (deprecated)
18767 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18768 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18769 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18770 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18771 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18772 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18773 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18774 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018776req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18777 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018778 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18779 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18780 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18781 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783 ACL alternatives :
18784 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18787 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18788 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18789 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18790 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018792 ACL alternatives :
18793 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797req.proto_http : boolean
18798req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18799 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18800 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18801 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18802 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18803 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18804 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18805 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807 Example:
18808 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18809 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18810 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018811 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018813req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18814rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18815 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18816 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18817 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18818 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18819 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18820 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18821 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018823 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18824 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18825 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18826 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18827 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18828 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018830 ACL derivatives :
18831 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 Example :
18834 listen tse-farm
18835 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18836 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18837 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18838 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18839 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18840 persist rdp-cookie
18841 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18842 # This is only useful makes sense if
18843 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18844 stick-table type string size 204800
18845 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18846 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18847 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18850 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18853rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18854 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18855 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18856 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18857 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859 ACL derivatives :
18860 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018861
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018862req.ssl_alpn : string
18863 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18864 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18865 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18866 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18867 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18868 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018869 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018870
18871 Examples :
18872 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18873 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18874 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018875 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018876 default_backend bk_default
18877
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018878req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18879 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18880 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018881 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18882 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18883 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18884 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18885 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018887req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18888req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18889 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18890 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18891 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18892 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18893 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18894 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18895 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018897req.ssl_sni : string
18898req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18899 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18900 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18901 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18902 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18903 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018904 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18905 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18906 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18907 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18908 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18909 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18910 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18911 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18912 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018914 ACL derivatives :
18915 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018917 Examples :
18918 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18919 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18920 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18921 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18922 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018923
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018924req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18925 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18926 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18927 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18928 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18929 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18930 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18931 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18932 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18933 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935req.ssl_ver : integer
18936req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18937 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18938 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18939 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18940 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18941 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18942 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18943 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018944 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018945 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018947 ACL derivatives :
18948 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018949
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018950res.len : integer
18951 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18952 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18953 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18954 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18955 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18956 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18957 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018958 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18961 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018962 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018963 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018964 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018965 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18968 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18969 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18970 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018971 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18972 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018975
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018976res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18977rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18978 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18979 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18980 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18981 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18982 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18983 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18984 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018986wait_end : boolean
18987 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18988 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018989 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18991 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018992 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18994 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996 Examples :
18997 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18998 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18999 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19002 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19003 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19004 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19005 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19006 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19007 tcp-request content reject
19008
19009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011--------------------------------------
19012
19013It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19014This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19015data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19016its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19017HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19018content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19019to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19020more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19021response are indexed.
19022
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019023Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19024 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19025 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19026 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19027 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19028 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19029 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019031base : string
19032 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19033 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19034 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19035 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19036 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19037 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19038 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19039 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19040
19041 ACL derivatives :
19042 base : exact string match
19043 base_beg : prefix match
19044 base_dir : subdir match
19045 base_dom : domain match
19046 base_end : suffix match
19047 base_len : length match
19048 base_reg : regex match
19049 base_sub : substring match
19050
19051base32 : integer
19052 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19053 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19054 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019055 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19056 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19057 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019058
19059base32+src : binary
19060 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19061 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19062 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19063 per-URL counters.
19064
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019065baseq : string
19066 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19067 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19068 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19069 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19070
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019071capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19072 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19073 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19074 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19075
19076capture.req.method : string
19077 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19078 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19079 because it's allocated.
19080
19081capture.req.uri : string
19082 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19083 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19084 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19085 allocated.
19086
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019087capture.req.ver : string
19088 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19089 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19090 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19091
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019092capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19093 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19094 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19095 The first entry is an index of 0.
19096 See also: "capture response header"
19097
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019098capture.res.ver : string
19099 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19100 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19101 persistent flag.
19102
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019103req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019104 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19105 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19106 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019107
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019108req.body_param([<name>) : string
19109 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19110 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19111 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19112 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19113 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19114 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19115 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19116 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19117 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19118 given.
19119
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019120req.body_len : integer
19121 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19122 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019123 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19124 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019125
19126req.body_size : integer
19127 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019128 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19129 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131req.cook([<name>]) : string
19132cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19133 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19134 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19135 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19136 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19137 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19138 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19139 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19140 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19141
19142 ACL derivatives :
19143 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19144 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19145 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19146 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19147 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19148 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19149 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19150 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019152req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19153cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19154 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19155 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19158cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19159 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19160 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19161 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19162 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19165 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19166 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19167 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19168 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019169 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19171 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19172 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19173 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019175hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19176 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19177 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19178 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19179 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019180 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019183 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19184 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19185 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19186 with headers such as User-Agent.
19187
19188 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19189 found.
19190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019191 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19192 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19193 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019194 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019196req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19197 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19198 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019199 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19200 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019203 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19204 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19205 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19206 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19207 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19208 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19209 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19210
19211 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19212 found.
19213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19215 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19216 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019217 with -1 being the last one.
19218
19219 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19220 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222 ACL derivatives :
19223 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19224 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19225 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19226 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19227 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19228 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19229 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19230 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19231
19232req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19233hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19234 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19235 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019236 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19237 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19238 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19239
19240 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19241 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19242 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19243
19244 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019245
19246req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19247hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19248 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19249 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19250 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019251 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19252 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19253 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19254 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19255 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019256
19257 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19258
19259 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019260
19261req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19262hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19263 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19264 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19265 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019266
19267 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19268
19269 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019271req.hdrs : string
19272 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19273 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19274 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19275 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19276
19277req.hdrs_bin : binary
19278 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19279 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19280 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19281 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19282 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19283 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19284
19285 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019286
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019287 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19288 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19291 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19292 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19293 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19294 basic auth is supported.
19295
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019296http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19297 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19298 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19299 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19300 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19302 basic auth is supported.
19303
19304 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019305 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19306 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19307 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19308 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019309
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019310http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019311 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19312 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19313 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019314
19315http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019316 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19317 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19318 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019319
19320http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019321 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19322 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19323 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019326 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19327 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19329 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019331method : integer + string
19332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19333 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19334 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19335 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19336 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19337 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19338 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019340 ACL derivatives :
19341 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343 Example :
19344 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19345 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19346 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348path : string
19349 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19350 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19351 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19352 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19353 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019354 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019357 ACL derivatives :
19358 path : exact string match
19359 path_beg : prefix match
19360 path_dir : subdir match
19361 path_dom : domain match
19362 path_end : suffix match
19363 path_len : length match
19364 path_reg : regex match
19365 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019366
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019367pathq : string
19368 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19369 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19370 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19371 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19372 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19373 result in both cases.
19374
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019375query : string
19376 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19377 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19378 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19379 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019380 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019381 which stops before the question mark.
19382
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019383req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19384 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19385 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19386 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19387 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389req.ver : string
19390req_ver : string (deprecated)
19391 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19392 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19393 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395 ACL derivatives :
19396 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019397
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019398res.body : binary
19399 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19400 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019401 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19402
19403 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019404
19405res.body_len : integer
19406 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19407 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019408 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19409
19410 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019411
19412res.body_size : integer
19413 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19414 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19415 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19416 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019417 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19418
19419 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019420
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019421res.cache_hit : boolean
19422 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19423 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19424
19425res.cache_name : string
19426 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19427 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19428 empty string.
19429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430res.comp : boolean
19431 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19432 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19433 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435res.comp_algo : string
19436 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19437 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19438 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440res.cook([<name>]) : string
19441scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19442 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19443 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019444 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19445
19446 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019448 ACL derivatives :
19449 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019451res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19452scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19453 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19454 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019455 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19456
19457 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19460scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19461 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19462 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019463 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19464
19465 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019467res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019468 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19469 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19470
19471 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19472 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19473
19474 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19475
19476 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019479 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19480 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19481
19482 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19483 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19484
19485 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019487res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19488shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019489 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19490 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19491
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019492 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019493 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19494
19495 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497 ACL derivatives :
19498 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19499 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19500 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19501 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19502 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19503 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19504 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19505 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19506
19507res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19508shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019509 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19510 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19511
19512 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019513 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019514
19515 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019517res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19518shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019519 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19520 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19521
19522 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19523
19524 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019525
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019526res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19527 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19528 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19529 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019530 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19531
19532 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019534res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19535shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019536 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19537 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19538
19539 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19540
19541 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019542
19543res.hdrs : string
19544 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19545 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19546 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019547 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19548
19549 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019550
19551res.hdrs_bin : binary
19552 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19553 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19554 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19555 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19556 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19557 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19558 (length of 0 for both).
19559
19560 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19561
19562 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19563 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019565res.ver : string
19566resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19567 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019568 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19569
19570 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019572 ACL derivatives :
19573 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19576 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19577 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019578 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019579 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19582 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584status : integer
19585 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19586 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019587 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19588
19589 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019590
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019591unique-id : string
19592 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19593 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19594 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19595 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19596 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19597 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019599url : string
19600 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19601 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19602 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19603 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19604 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19605 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19606 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608 ACL derivatives :
19609 url : exact string match
19610 url_beg : prefix match
19611 url_dir : subdir match
19612 url_dom : domain match
19613 url_end : suffix match
19614 url_len : length match
19615 url_reg : regex match
19616 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618url_ip : ip
19619 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19620 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19621 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19622 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19623 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19624 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19625 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627url_port : integer
19628 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19629 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19630 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19631 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019632
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019633urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19634url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019635 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19636 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019637 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19638 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19639 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19640 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19642 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019643 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19644 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019646 ACL derivatives :
19647 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19648 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19649 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19650 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19651 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19652 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19653 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19654 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019655
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019657 Example :
19658 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19659 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19660 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19661 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019662
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019663urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19665 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19666 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019667
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019668url32 : integer
19669 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19670 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19671 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19672 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19673 is an unsigned integer.
19674
19675url32+src : binary
19676 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19677 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19678 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19679
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019680
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200196817.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019682---------------------------------------
19683
19684This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19685used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19686purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19687There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19688or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19689any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19690for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19691
19692internal.htx.data : integer
19693 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19694 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19695
19696internal.htx.free : integer
19697 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19698 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19699
19700internal.htx.free_data : integer
19701 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19702 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19703
19704internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019705 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19706 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19707 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019708
19709internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19710 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19711 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19712
19713internal.htx.size : integer
19714 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19715 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19716
19717internal.htx.used : integer
19718 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19719 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19720 direction.
19721
19722internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19723 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19724 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19725 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19726 of the special value :
19727 * head : The oldest inserted block
19728 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019729 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019730
19731internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19732 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19733 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19734 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19735 integer or one of the special value :
19736 * head : The oldest inserted block
19737 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019738 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019739
19740internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19741 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19742 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19743 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19744 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19745
19746 * head : The oldest inserted block
19747 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019748 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019749
19750internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19751 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19752 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19753 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19754 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19755
19756 * head : The oldest inserted block
19757 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019758 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019759
19760internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19761 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19762 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19763 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19764 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19765
19766 * head : The oldest inserted block
19767 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019768 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019769
19770internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19771 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19772 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19773 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19774 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19775
19776 * head : The oldest inserted block
19777 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019778 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019779
19780internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19781 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19782 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19783 it returns false.
19784
19785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200197867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019787---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019789Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19790every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019791order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019793ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019794---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19795FALSE always_false never match
19796HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19797HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19798HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019799HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019800HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19801HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19802HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19803HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19804LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19805METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19806METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19807METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19808METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19809METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19810METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19811METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19812METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19813RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19814REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19815TRUE always_true always match
19816WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19817---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019818
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198208. Logging
19821----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019822
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019823One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19824provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19825very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19826provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19827state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019828to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019829headers.
19830
19831In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19832about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19833send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19834
19835 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19836 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19837 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19838 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19839 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019840 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019841 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019842
19843The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19844allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19845as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19846while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19847real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19848delay.
19849
19850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198518.1. Log levels
19852---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019854TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019855source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019856HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19857in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19858track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19859syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19860about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019861
19862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198638.2. Log formats
19864----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019865
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019866HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019867and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19868slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19869options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019870
19871 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19872 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19873 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19874 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19875 extents.
19876
19877 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19878 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19879 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19880 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19881 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19882
19883 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19884 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19885 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19886 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19887 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19888
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019889 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19890 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19891 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19892 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19893
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019894 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19895
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019896Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19897specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19898field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19899servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19900always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19901identifier.
19902
19903Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19904 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19905 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19906 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19907 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19908
19909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199108.2.1. Default log format
19911-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
19913This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19914as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19915format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19916
19917 Example :
19918 listen www
19919 mode http
19920 log global
19921 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19922
19923 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19924 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19925 (www/HTTP)
19926
19927 Field Format Extract from the example above
19928 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19929 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19930 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19931 4 'to' to
19932 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19933 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19934
19935Detailed fields description :
19936 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19937 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19938 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19939 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19940 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19941 and processed the connection.
19942 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19943
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019944In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19945"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19946connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019948It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19949will eventually disappear.
19950
19951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199528.2.2. TCP log format
19953---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019954
19955The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19956is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19957information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19958counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19959emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19960environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19961the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19962sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019963specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19964not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19965fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19966marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019967
19968 Example :
19969 frontend fnt
19970 mode tcp
19971 option tcplog
19972 log global
19973 default_backend bck
19974
19975 backend bck
19976 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19977
19978 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19979 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19980 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19981
19982 Field Format Extract from the example above
19983 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19984 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19985 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19986 4 frontend_name fnt
19987 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19988 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19989 7 bytes_read* 212
19990 8 termination_state --
19991 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19992 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19993
19994Detailed fields description :
19995 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019996 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19997 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19998 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019999 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020000 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020001 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020002
20003 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020004 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20005 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20006 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020007
20008 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20009 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20010 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020011 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20012 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20013 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20014 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020015
20016 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20017 and processed the connection.
20018
20019 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20020 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20021 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20022 applications.
20023
20024 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20025 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20026 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20027 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20028 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20029
20030 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20031 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20032 See "Timers" below for more details.
20033
20034 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20035 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20036 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20037 "Timers" below for more details.
20038
20039 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020040 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20042 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20043 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20044 details.
20045
20046 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20047 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20048 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20049 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20050 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20051
20052 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20053 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20054 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20055 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20056 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20057 for more details.
20058
20059 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020060 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020061 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20062 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20063 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020064 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
20066 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20067 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20068 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20069 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20070 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20071 caused by a denial of service attack.
20072
20073 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20074 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20075 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20076 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20077 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20078 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20079 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20080 denial of service attack.
20081
20082 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20083 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20084 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20085 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20086 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20087 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20088 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20089 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20090 be processed than on other servers.
20091
20092 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20093 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20094 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20095 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20096 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20097 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20098 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20099 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20100 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20101 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20102 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20103 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20104 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20105
20106 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20107 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20108 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20109 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20110 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20111 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020112 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20114
20115 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20116 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20117 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20118 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20119 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20120 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020121 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020122 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20123 occurs.
20124
20125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201268.2.3. HTTP log format
20127----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020128
20129The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20130is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20131the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20132are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20133emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20134generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20135"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20136which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020137frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20138is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020139
20140Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20141slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20142with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20143
20144 Example :
20145 frontend http-in
20146 mode http
20147 option httplog
20148 log global
20149 default_backend bck
20150
20151 backend static
20152 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20153
20154 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20155 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20156 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020157 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020158
20159 Field Format Extract from the example above
20160 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20161 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020162 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020163 4 frontend_name http-in
20164 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020165 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020166 7 status_code 200
20167 8 bytes_read* 2750
20168 9 captured_request_cookie -
20169 10 captured_response_cookie -
20170 11 termination_state ----
20171 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20172 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20173 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20174 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20175 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020176
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020177Detailed fields description :
20178 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020179 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20180 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20181 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020182 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020183 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020184 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185
20186 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020187 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20188 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20189 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020190
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020191 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20192 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020193
20194 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20195 and processed the connection.
20196
20197 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20198 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20199 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20200
20201 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20202 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20203 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20204 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20205 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20206 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20207
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020208 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20209 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20210 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020211 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020212 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20213 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020214 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20215 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216
20217 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20218 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020219 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220
20221 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20222 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020223 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20224 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020225
20226 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20227 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20228 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20229 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20230 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020231 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20232 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020234 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20235 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20236 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20237 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20238 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20239 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20240 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020241 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020242
20243 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20244 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20245 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20246
20247 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20248 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020249 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020250 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20251 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20252 overflowing.
20253
20254 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20255 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20256 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20257 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20258 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20259 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20260 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20261 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20262
20263 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20264 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20265 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20266 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20267 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20268 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20269 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20270 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20271
20272 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20273 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20274 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20275 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20276 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20277 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20278 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20279
20280 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020281 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020282 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20283 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20284 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020285 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020286 system.
20287
20288 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20289 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20290 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20291 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20292 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20293 caused by a denial of service attack.
20294
20295 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20296 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20297 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20298 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20299 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20300 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20301 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20302 denial of service attack.
20303
20304 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20305 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20306 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20307 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20308 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20309 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20310 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20311 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20312 processed than on other servers.
20313
20314 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20315 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20316 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20317 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20318 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20319 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20320 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20321 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20322 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20323 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20324 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20325 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20326 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20327
20328 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20329 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20330 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20331 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20332 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20333 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020334 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20336
20337 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20338 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20339 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20340 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20341 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20342 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020343 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020344 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20345 occurs.
20346
20347 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20348 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20349 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20350 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20351 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20352 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20353 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20354 cookies" below for more details.
20355
20356 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20357 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20358 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20359 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20360 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20361 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20362 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20363 and cookies" below for more details.
20364
20365 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20366 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20367 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20368 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20369 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20370 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20371 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20372 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20373
20374
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200203758.2.4. Custom log format
20376------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020377
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020378The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020379mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020380
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020381HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020382Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20383separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20384prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20385
20386Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20387variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020388("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020389
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020390If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020391as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020392less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20393the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20394
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020395Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20396"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20397delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20398preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020399
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020400Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20401'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20402https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20403such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20404
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020405Flags are :
20406 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020407 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020408 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20409 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020410
20411 Example:
20412
20413 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20414 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20415
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020416 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20417
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020418At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020420 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20421 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020422
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020423the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020424
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020425 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20426 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20427 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020428
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020429and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020431 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20432 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020433
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020434Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20435
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020436 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020437 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020438 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20439 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20440 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020441 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20442 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20443 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020444 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020445 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020446 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020447 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020448 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020449 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20450 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020451 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020452 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020453 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020454 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020455 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020456 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020457 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020458 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20459 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20460 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20461 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20462 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020463 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020464 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020465 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020466 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020467 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020468 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20469 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020470 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20471 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20472 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020473 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020474 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20475 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020476 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020477 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20478 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20479 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020480 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020481 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020482 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20483 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20484 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20485 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020486 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020487 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020488 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020489 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020490 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020491 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020492 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20493 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20494 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020495 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020496 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20497 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020498 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020499 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20500 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020501 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020502 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020503 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020504 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020505
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020506 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020507
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020508
205098.2.5. Error log format
20510-----------------------
20511
20512When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20513protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20514By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20515"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020516will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020517logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20518
20519The format looks like this :
20520
20521 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20522 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20523 Connection error during SSL handshake
20524
20525 Field Format Extract from the example above
20526 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20527 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20528 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20529 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20530 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20531
20532These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20533failures.
20534
20535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205368.3. Advanced logging options
20537-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020538
20539Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20540just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20541options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20542for more information about their usage.
20543
20544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205458.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20546------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020547
20548It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20549haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20550commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20551monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20552ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20553
20554 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20555 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20556 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20557 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20558
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020559 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20560 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020561
20562 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20563 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20564 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20565
20566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205678.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20568----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569
20570The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20571what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20572or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020573"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20575log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20576after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20577is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20578with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20579with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20580
20581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20583------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020584
20585Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20586for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20587"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20588retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20589raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20590a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20591file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20592you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20593"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20594
20595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205968.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20597--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020598
20599Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20600multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20601them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20602"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20603logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20604error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20605and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20606too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20607useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20608alternative.
20609
20610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206118.4. Timing events
20612------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020613
20614Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20615reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20616the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20617frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020618mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20619addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20620
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020621Timings events in HTTP mode:
20622
20623 first request 2nd request
20624 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20625 t tr t tr ...
20626 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20627 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20628 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20629 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020630 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020631 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20632
20633Timings events in TCP mode:
20634
20635 TCP session
20636 |<----------------->|
20637 t t
20638 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20639 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20640 |<------ Tt ------->|
20641
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020642 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020643 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020644 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20645 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20646 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020647 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020648 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20649 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20650 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20651 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020652
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020653 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20654 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20655 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020656 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20657 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20658 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20659 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20660 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20661 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020662
20663 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20664 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20665 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20666 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20667 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20668 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20669 request typed by hand during a test.
20670
20671 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20672 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020673 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020674 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20675 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20676 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20677 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020678
20679 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20680 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20681 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20682 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20683 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20684
20685 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20686 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20687 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20688 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20689 connection never established.
20690
20691 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20692 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20693 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20694 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20695 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20696 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20697 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20698 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20699 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20700 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20701 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20702
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020703 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20704 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20705 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20706 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20707 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20708 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20709
20710 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20711
20712 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20713 "Ta" can never be negative.
20714
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020715 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20716 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020717 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20718 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020719 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020720
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020721 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020722
20723 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020724 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20725 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020726
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020727 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20728 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20729 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20730 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20731 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20732 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20733 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20734 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020736These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20737protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20738that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020739due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20740"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20741that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020742
20743Most common cases :
20744
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020745 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20746 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20747 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20748 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20749 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20750 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20751 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20752 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20753 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20754 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20755 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020756 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020757
20758 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20759 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20760 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20761 of ms on remote networks.
20762
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020763 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20764 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20765 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020766
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020767 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20768 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20769 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20770 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20771 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20772 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20773 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20774 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20775 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020776
20777Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20778
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020779 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020780 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020781 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020783 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020784 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20785 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20786
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020787 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20789 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20790 flags.
20791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020792 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20793 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020794 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20795 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20796 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20797 the client connection was maintained open.
20798
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020799 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020800 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020801 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020802 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20803
20804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208058.5. Session state at disconnection
20806-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020807
20808TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20809"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20811each of which has a special meaning :
20812
20813 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20814 session to terminate :
20815
20816 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20817
20818 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20819 server explicitly refused it.
20820
20821 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20822 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20823 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20824 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020825 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020826
20827 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20828 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829
20830 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20831 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20832 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20833 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20834 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20835
20836 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20837 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20838 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20839 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20840 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20841
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020842 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20843 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20844
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020845 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20846 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20847 backup connections when going up.
20848
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020849 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20850
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020851 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20852 send or receive data.
20853
20854 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20855 send or receive data.
20856
20857 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20858 with nothing left in the buffers.
20859
20860 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20861
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020862 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020863 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20864
20865 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20866 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20867 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20868 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20869 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20870
20871 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20872 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20873
20874 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20875 server (HTTP only).
20876
20877 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20878
20879 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20880 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20881 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20882
20883 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20884 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20885 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20886
20887 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20888
20889 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20890 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20891
20892 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20893 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20894 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20895
20896 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20897 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020898 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20899 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020900
20901 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20902 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20903 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20904 another server.
20905
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020906 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020907 server.
20908
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020909 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20910 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20911 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20912 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20913
20914 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20915 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20916 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20917 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20918
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020919 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20920 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20921 "use-server" rule).
20922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20924
20925 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20926 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20927
20928 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20929
20930 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20931 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20932 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20933
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020934 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20935 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020936 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020937 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20938 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20939
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20941
20942 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20943 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20944
20945 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20946
20947 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20948
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020949The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20950was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020951helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20952starvation, attacks, etc...
20953
20954The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20955alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20956easier finding and understanding.
20957
20958 Flags Reason
20959
20960 -- Normal termination.
20961
20962 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20963 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20964 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20965 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20966
20967 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20968 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20969 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20970 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20971 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20972 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020973
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020974 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20975 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020976 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020977
20978 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20979 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20980 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20981
20982 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20983 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20984 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20985 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20986 the server takes too long to respond.
20987
20988 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20989 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20990 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20991 long a time to respond.
20992
20993 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20994 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20995 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20996 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020997 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20998 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999
21000 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21001 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21002 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21003 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21004 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021005 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021006 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21007 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21008 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21009 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21010 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21011 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21012 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21013 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021014 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021015 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21016 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21017 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021018
21019 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21020 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021021 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21022 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21023 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21024 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021025
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021026 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21027 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021029 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021030 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21031 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021032 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021033 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21034 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21035
21036 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21037 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21038 503 or 504 here.
21039
21040 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21041 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21042 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21043 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21044 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21045
21046 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21047 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021048 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021049 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21050 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21051
21052 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21053 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21054 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21055 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21056 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21057 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21058 between haproxy and the server.
21059
21060 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21061 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21062 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21063 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21064 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21065 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21066 solution is to fix the application.
21067
21068 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21069 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21070 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21071 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21072 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21073 external attacks.
21074
21075 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021076 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021077 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21079 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21080
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021081 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21082 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21083 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021084 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021085 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21088 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21089 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21090 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021091 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21092 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21093 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21094 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21095 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021096
21097 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21098 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21099 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21100 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21101
21102 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21103 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21104 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21105 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21106
21107 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21108 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21109 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21110 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21111
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021112The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21113persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21114important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21115re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21116
21117 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21118
21119 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21120 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21121 set on a GET request.
21122
21123 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21124 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021125 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021126 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21127
21128 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21129 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21130 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21131
21132 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21133 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21134 already got a cookie.
21135
21136 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21137 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21138 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21139 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21140 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21141
21142 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21143 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21144 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21145
21146 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21147 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21148 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21149
21150 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21151 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21152
21153 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21154 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21155 then advertised in the response.
21156
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211588.6. Non-printable characters
21159-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021160
21161In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21162consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21163converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21164prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21165being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21166escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21167is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21168'}' when logging headers.
21169
21170Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21171issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21172containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21173
21174Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21175the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21176performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21177
21178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211798.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21180---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021181
21182Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21183achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021184section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21186the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21187the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021188locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021189not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21190user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21191a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21192wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21193
21194 Examples :
21195 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21196 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21197
21198 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21199 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21200
21201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21203---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021204
21205Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21206proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21207the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21208server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21209
21210Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21211response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021212section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021213
21214It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021215time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21216appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021217are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21218and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21219follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21220request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21221in the logs.
21222
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021223As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21224frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21225an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21226
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227 Example :
21228 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21229 listen proxy-out
21230 mode http
21231 option httplog
21232 option logasap
21233 log global
21234 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21235
21236 # log the name of the virtual server
21237 capture request header Host len 20
21238
21239 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21240 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21241
21242 # log the beginning of the referrer
21243 capture request header Referer len 20
21244
21245 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21246 capture response header Server len 20
21247
21248 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21249 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021251 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021252 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21253
21254 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21255 capture response header Via len 20
21256
21257 # log the URL location during a redirection
21258 capture response header Location len 20
21259
21260 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21261 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21262 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21263 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21264 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21265
21266 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21267 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21268 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21269 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021270 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271
21272 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21273 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21274 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21275 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21276 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021277 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021278
21279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212808.9. Examples of logs
21281---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021282
21283These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21284them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21285reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21286
21287 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21288 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21289 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21290
21291 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21292 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21293
21294 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21295 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21296 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21297
21298 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21299 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21300
21301 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21302 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21303 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21304
21305 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021306 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021307 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21308 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21309
21310 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21311 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21312 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21313
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021314 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21315 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21316 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21317 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21318 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21319 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320
21321 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021322 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021323
21324 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21325 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21326 Nothing was sent to any server.
21327
21328 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21329 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21330
21331 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21332 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021333 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021334 send a 408 return code to the client.
21335
21336 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21337 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21338
21339 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21340 5 seconds ("c----").
21341
21342 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21343 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021344 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021345
21346 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021347 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021348 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21349 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21350 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21351 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21352 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021353
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021354
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200213559. Supported filters
21356--------------------
21357
21358Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21359accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21360unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21361
21362See also : "filter"
21363
213649.1. Trace
21365----------
21366
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021367filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021368
21369 Arguments:
21370 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21371 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21372
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021373 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021375 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021376 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21377 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21378 amount of the parsed data.
21379
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021380 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021381
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021382This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21383callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21384information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21385filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21386
21387Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21388tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21389a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21390
21391
213929.2. HTTP compression
21393---------------------
21394
21395filter compression
21396
21397The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21398keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021399when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21400fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21401done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21402explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21403filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21404listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21405order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021406
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021407See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21408 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021409
21410
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21412--------------------------------------------
21413
21414filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21415
21416 Arguments :
21417
21418 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21419 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21420 parsed.
21421
21422 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21423 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21424 part must be placed in its own scope.
21425
21426The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21427external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021428streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021429exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21430also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21431
21432SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21433the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21434
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021435For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021436"doc/SPOE.txt".
21437
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214389.4. Cache
21439----------
21440
21441filter cache <name>
21442
21443 Arguments :
21444
21445 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21446
21447The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21448"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021449cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021450other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21451case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21452is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21453filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021454listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21455order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021456
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021457See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21458 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21459
21460
214619.5. Fcgi-app
21462-------------
21463
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021464filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021465
21466 Arguments :
21467
21468 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21469
21470The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21471request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21472reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21473used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21474implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21475used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21476fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21477used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21478order.
21479
21480See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21481 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21482
21483
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100214849.6. OpenTracing
21485----------------
21486
21487The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21488HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21489of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21490Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21491
21492This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21493
21494The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21495HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21496participates in the work of HAProxy.
21497
21498filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21499
21500 Arguments :
21501
21502 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21503 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21504 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21505 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21506 OpenTracing filters.
21507
21508 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21509 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21510 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21511 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21512 filter must have its own scope defined.
21513
21514More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021515of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021516
21517
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002151810. FastCGI applications
21519-------------------------
21520
21521HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21522feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21523the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21524FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21525servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21526FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21527backend.
21528
21529HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21530application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21531connection.
21532
2153310.1. Setup
21534-----------
21535
2153610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21537--------------------------
21538
21539fcgi-app <name>
21540 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21541 document root must be defined.
21542
21543acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21544 Declare or complete an access list.
21545
21546 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21547 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21548 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21549 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21550 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21551
21552docroot <path>
21553 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21554 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21555 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21556
21557index <script-name>
21558 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21559 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21560 is an optional setting.
21561
21562 Example :
21563 index index.php
21564
21565log-stderr global
21566log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021567 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021568 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21569
21570 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21571 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21572
21573pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21574 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21575 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21576 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21577
21578 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21579 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21580 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21581 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21582
21583 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21584 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21585
21586path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021587 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021588 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21589 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21590 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21591 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21592 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21593 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21594 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021595
21596 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021597 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021598 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21599 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21600 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21601 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021602
21603 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021604 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21605 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021606
21607option get-values
21608no option get-values
21609 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21610
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021611 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021612 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21613
21614 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21615 application will accept.
21616
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021617 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21618 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021619
21620 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021621 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021622 option is disabled.
21623
21624 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21625 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21626 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21627 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21628 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21629 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21630
21631option keep-conn
21632no option keep-conn
21633 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21634 sending a response.
21635
21636 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21637 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21638
21639option max-reqs <reqs>
21640 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21641 accept.
21642
21643 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21644 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21645 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21646 to 1.
21647
21648option mpxs-conns
21649no option mpxs-conns
21650 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21651
21652 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21653 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21654
21655set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21656 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21657 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21658 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21659 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21660
21661 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21662 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21663 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21664
21665 Example :
21666 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21667 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21668
21669 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21670
21671
2167210.1.2. Proxy section
21673---------------------
21674
21675use-fcgi-app <name>
21676 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21677
21678 Arguments :
21679 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21680
21681 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21682 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21683 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21684 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21685 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21686
21687 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21688 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21689 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21690 application are evaluated.
21691
21692
2169310.1.3. Example
21694---------------
21695
21696 frontend front-http
21697 mode http
21698 bind *:80
21699 bind *:
21700
21701 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21702 default_backend back-static
21703
21704 backend back-static
21705 mode http
21706 server www A.B.C.D:80
21707
21708 backend back-dynamic
21709 mode http
21710 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21711 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21712
21713 fcgi-app php-fpm
21714 log-stderr global
21715 option keep-conn
21716
21717 docroot /var/www/my-app
21718 index index.php
21719 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21720
21721
2172210.2. Default parameters
21723------------------------
21724
21725A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21726the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021727script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021728applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21729
21730 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21731 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21732 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21733 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21734 | | |
21735 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21736 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21737 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21738 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21739 | | application. |
21740 | | |
21741 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21742 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21743 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21744 | | |
21745 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21746 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21747 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21748 | | the application's configuration. |
21749 | | |
21750 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21751 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21752 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21753 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21754 | | |
21755 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21756 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21757 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21758 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21759 | | be defined. |
21760 | | |
21761 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21762 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21763 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21764 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21765 | | is not set too. |
21766 | | |
21767 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21768 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21769 | | set. |
21770 | | |
21771 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21772 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21773 | | the request. |
21774 | | |
21775 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21776 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21777 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21778 | | |
21779 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21780 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21781 | | script to process the request. |
21782 | | |
21783 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21784 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21785 | | |
21786 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21787 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21788 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21789 | | |
21790 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21791 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21792 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21793 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21794 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21795 | | |
21796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21797 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21798 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21799 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21800 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21801 | | side. |
21802 | | |
21803 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21804 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21805 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21806 | | connected to. |
21807 | | |
21808 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21809 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21810 | | |
21811 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21812 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21813 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21814 | | |
21815 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21816
21817
2181810.3. Limitations
21819------------------
21820
21821The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21822way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21823during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21824establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21825application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21826or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21827message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21828these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21829and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21830
21831Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21832request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21833requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21834
21835About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21836into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21837fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21838"http-request" ones.
21839
21840Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21841FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21842processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21843must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21844here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021845
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021846
2184711. Address formats
21848-------------------
21849
21850Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21851address.
21852
21853This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21854The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21855of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21856equivalent is '::'.
21857
21858Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21859is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21860
21861This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21862family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21863
21864Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21865configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21866use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21867'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21868
21869Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21870socket type and the transport method.
21871
21872
2187311.1 Address family prefixes
21874----------------------------
21875
21876'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21877
21878'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21879 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21880 listening.
21881
21882'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21883 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21884 on the statement using this address, a port or
21885 a port range may or must be specified.
21886
21887'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21888 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21889 using this address, a port or a port range
21890 may or must be specified.
21891
21892'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21893 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21894 using this address, a port or a port range
21895 may or must be specified.
21896
21897'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21898 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21899 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21900 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21901 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21902 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21903
21904'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21905 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21906 start by slash '/'.
21907
21908
2190911.2 Socket type prefixes
21910-------------------------
21911
21912Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21913type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21914this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21915This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21916but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21917
21918Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21919instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21920
21921If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21922they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21923report this to the maintainers.
21924
21925'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21926 to "stream"
21927
21928'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21929 to "datagram".
21930
21931
2193211.3 Protocol prefixes
21933----------------------
21934
21935'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21936 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21937 socket type and transport method is forced to
21938 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21939 this address, a port or a port range can or
21940 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21941 of 'stream+ip@'.
21942
21943'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21944 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21945 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21946 statement using this address, a port or port
21947 range can or must be specified.
21948 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21949
21950'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21951 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21952 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21953 statement using this address, a port or port
21954 range can or must be specified.
21955 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21956
21957'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21958 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21959 socket type and transport method is forced to
21960 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21961 this address, a port or a port range can or
21962 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21963 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21964
21965'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21966 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21967 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21968 the statement using this address, a port or
21969 port range can or must be specified.
21970 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21971
21972'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21973 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21974 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21975 the statement using this address, a port or
21976 port range can or must be specified.
21977 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21978
21979'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21980 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21981 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21982
21983'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21984 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21985 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21986
21987In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21988QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021990/*
21991 * Local variables:
21992 * fill-column: 79
21993 * End:
21994 */